blob: 86392dd57c28d53ad7ce484c459191b784a85de1 [file] [log] [blame]
Christ van Willegend65cdad2025-05-30 16:05:58 +02001*options.txt* For Vim version 9.1. Last change: 2025 May 30
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002
3
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
5
6
7Options *options*
8
91. Setting options |set-option|
102. Automatically setting options |auto-setting|
113. Options summary |option-summary|
12
Bram Moolenaar2ec618c2016-10-01 14:47:05 +020013For an overview of options see quickref.txt |option-list|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000014
15Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to
16achieve special effects. These options come in three forms:
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle*
18 number has a numeric value
19 string has a string value
20
21==============================================================================
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +0000221. Setting options *set-option* *E764*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000023
24 *:se* *:set*
Bram Moolenaar6b915c02020-01-18 15:53:19 +010025:se[t][!] Show all options that differ from their default value.
26 When [!] is present every option is on a separate
27 line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000028
Bram Moolenaar6b915c02020-01-18 15:53:19 +010029:se[t][!] all Show all but terminal options.
30 When [!] is present every option is on a separate
31 line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000032
33:se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the
34 key codes are not shown, because they are generated
35 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal
36 codes in the GUI is not useful either...
Bram Moolenaarf1dcd142022-12-31 15:30:45 +000037 The options have the form t_AB, see
38 |terminal-options|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000039
Bram Moolenaar47003982021-12-05 21:54:04 +000040:se[t]! termcap Idem, but don't use multiple columns.
41
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000042 *E518* *E519*
43:se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}.
44
45:se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on.
46 Number option: show value.
47 String option: show value.
48
49:se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off.
50
Bram Moolenaar00a927d2010-05-14 23:24:24 +020051 *:set-!* *:set-inv*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000052:se[t] {option}! or
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +020053:se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000054
55 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim*
56:se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +020057 current value of 'compatible'.
58:se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value.
59:se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000060
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +010061:se[t] all& Set all options to their default value. The values of
Bram Moolenaar88774fd2015-08-25 19:52:04 +020062 these options are not changed:
63 all terminal options, starting with t_
64 'columns'
65 'cryptmethod'
66 'encoding'
67 'key'
68 'lines'
69 'term'
70 'ttymouse'
71 'ttytype'
72 Warning: This may have a lot of side effects.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000073
h_east59858792023-10-25 22:47:05 +090074 *:set-args* *:set=* *E487* *E521*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000075:se[t] {option}={value} or
76:se[t] {option}:{value}
77 Set string or number option to {value}.
78 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal,
Doug Kearnsddbb6fe2024-07-24 20:21:22 +020079 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0' or
80 '0o').
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000081 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by
82 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is
Yee Cheng Chin900894b2023-09-29 20:42:32 +020083 set). Many string options with fixed syntax and names
84 also support completing known values. See
85 |cmdline-completion| and |complete-set-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000086 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and
87 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value}
88 is not allowed.
89 See |option-backslash| for using white space and
90 backslashes in {value}.
91
92:se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=*
93 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the
94 {value} to a string option. When the option is a
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +010095 comma-separated list, a comma is added, unless the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000096 value was empty.
97 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +000098 are removed. When adding a flag that was already
99 present the option value doesn't change.
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000100 Also see |:set-args| above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000101
102:se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=*
103 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend
104 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +0100105 comma-separated list, a comma is added, unless the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000106 value was empty.
107 Also see |:set-args| above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000108
109:se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=*
110 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove
111 the {value} from a string option, if it is there.
112 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there
113 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma
114 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option
115 becomes empty.
116 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be
117 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags
118 one by one to avoid problems.
Yee Cheng Chin900894b2023-09-29 20:42:32 +0200119 The individual values from a comma separated list or
120 list of flags can be inserted by typing 'wildchar'.
121 See |complete-set-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000122 Also see |:set-args| above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000123
124The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: >
125 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3
126If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given
127and the following arguments will be ignored.
128
129 *:set-verbose*
130When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it
131was last set. Example: >
132 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent?
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +0200133< shiftwidth=4 ~
134 Last set from modeline line 1 ~
135 cindent ~
136 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim line 30 ~
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000137This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":verbose
138set all" or ":verbose set" without an argument.
139When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000140When the option was set while executing a function, user command or
141autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported.
142Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting
143'compatible'.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000144A few special texts:
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +0200145 Last set from modeline line 1 ~
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000146 Option was set in a |modeline|.
147 Last set from --cmd argument ~
148 Option was set with command line argument |--cmd| or +.
149 Last set from -c argument ~
150 Option was set with command line argument |-c|, +, |-S| or
151 |-q|.
152 Last set from environment variable ~
153 Option was set from an environment variable, $VIMINIT,
154 $GVIMINIT or $EXINIT.
155 Last set from error handler ~
156 Option was cleared when evaluating it resulted in an error.
157
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +0200158{not available when compiled without the |+eval| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000159
160 *:set-termcap* *E522*
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +0000161For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000162override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If
163the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: >
164 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot
165This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For
166example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: >
167 :set <M-b>=^[b
168(the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it)
169The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations.
170
Bram Moolenaar0b2f94d2011-03-22 14:35:05 +0100171You can define any key codes, e.g.: >
172 :set t_xy=^[foo;
173There is no warning for using a name that isn't recognized. You can map these
174codes as you like: >
175 :map <t_xy> something
176< *E846*
177When a key code is not set, it's like it does not exist. Trying to get its
178value will result in an error: >
179 :set t_kb=
180 :set t_kb
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +0000181< E846: Key code not set: t_kb ~
Bram Moolenaar0b2f94d2011-03-22 14:35:05 +0100182
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +0000183The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
184security reasons.
185
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000186The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000187at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000188"set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the
189|more-prompt|.
190
191 *option-backslash*
192To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a
193backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this
194means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded
195down).
Yee Cheng Chin54844852023-10-09 18:12:31 +0200196In options 'path', 'cdpath', and 'tags', spaces have to be preceded with three
197backslashes instead for compatibility with version 3.0 where the options can
198be separated by either commas or spaces.
199Comma-separated options like 'backupdir' and 'tags' will also require commas
200to be escaped with two backslashes, whereas this is not needed for
201non-comma-separated ones like 'makeprg'.
202When setting options using |:let| and |literal-string|, you need to use one
203fewer layer of backslash.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000204A few examples: >
Yee Cheng Chin54844852023-10-09 18:12:31 +0200205 :set makeprg=make\ file results in "make file"
206 :let &makeprg='make file' (same as above)
207 :set makeprg=make\\\ file results in "make\ file"
208 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags" and "/usr/tags"
209 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags file"
210 :let &tags='tags\ file' (same as above)
211
212 :set makeprg=make,file results in "make,file"
213 :set makeprg=make\\,file results in "make\,file"
214 :set tags=tags,file results in "tags" and "file"
Qiming zhaoab2fe652025-04-12 11:40:17 +0200215 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file"
Yee Cheng Chin54844852023-10-09 18:12:31 +0200216 :let &tags='tags\,file' (same as above)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000217
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000218The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To
219include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000220'titlestring' option to "hi|there": >
221 :set titlestring=hi\|there
222This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": >
223 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there
224
Bram Moolenaar89a9c152021-08-29 21:55:35 +0200225Similarly, in legacy script the double quote character starts a comment. To
226include the '"' in the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the
227'titlestring' option to 'hi "there"': >
Bram Moolenaar7df351e2006-01-23 22:30:28 +0000228 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\"
229
Bram Moolenaar89a9c152021-08-29 21:55:35 +0200230In |Vim9| script it's simpler, comments start with a '#' character, and only
231when preceded by white space. A backslash is needed less often: >
232 vim9script
233 set titlestring=hi\ "there"
234 set titlestring=hi#there#
235 set titlestring=hi\ \#there#
236
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +0100237For Win32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More precise: For
238options that expect a file name (those where environment variables are
239expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not removed. But
240a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma, etc.) is used
241like explained above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000242There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": >
243 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path"
244 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path"
245 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!)
246For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes
247are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000248halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000249result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it.
250
251 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags*
252 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552*
253Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an
254option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: >
255 :set guioptions+=a
256Remove a flag from an option like this: >
257 :set guioptions-=a
258This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000259Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000260the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba"
261doesn't appear.
262
263 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var*
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +0000264Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000265environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable
266name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name
267are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may
268follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is
269appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: >
270 :set term=$TERM.new
271 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,.
272When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set
273opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing.
274
275
276Handling of local options *local-options*
277
Christian Brabandt4a8eb6e2023-08-13 19:43:42 +0200278Note: The following also applies to |global-local| options.
279
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000280Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +0100281has its own copy of this option, thus each can have its own value. This
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000282allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set
283'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another.
284
285The following explains what happens to these local options in specific
286situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses
287the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user
288expects is a bit complicated...
289
290When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus
291right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same.
292
293When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since
294the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer,
295these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a
296global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and
297global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed,
298thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer.
299
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +0200300When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the options from the window
301that was last closed are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this
302window, the values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the
303last closed window where the buffer was edited last are used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000304
305It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer.
306When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep
307using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the
308local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window
309has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but
310global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: >
311 :e one
312 :set list
313 :e two
314Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list"
315command you have also set the global value. >
316 :set nolist
317 :e one
318 :setlocal list
319 :e two
320Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global
321value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the
322global value. Note that if you do this next: >
323 :e one
Bram Moolenaar531da592013-05-06 05:58:55 +0200324You will get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited "one".
325The options local to a window are remembered for each buffer. This also
326happens when the buffer is not loaded, but they are lost when the buffer is
327wiped out |:bwipe|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000328
Christian Brabandt596ad662023-08-16 00:11:09 +0200329Special local window options *local-noglobal*
Christian Brabandt4a8eb6e2023-08-13 19:43:42 +0200330
331The following local window options won't be copied over when new windows are
332created, thus they behave slightly differently:
333
334 Option Reason ~
335 'previewwindow' there can only be a single one
336 'scroll' specific to existing window
zeertzjq0049a492024-03-11 23:13:16 +0800337 'winfixbuf' specific to existing window
Christian Brabandt4a8eb6e2023-08-13 19:43:42 +0200338 'winfixheight' specific to existing window
339 'winfixwidth' specific to existing window
340
Christian Brabandt596ad662023-08-16 00:11:09 +0200341Special local buffer options
Christian Brabandt4a8eb6e2023-08-13 19:43:42 +0200342
343The following local buffer options won't be copied over when new buffers are
344created, thus they behave slightly differently:
345
346 Option Reason ~
347 'filetype' explicitly set by autocommands
348 'syntax' explicitly set by autocommands
349 'bufhidden' denote |special-buffers|
350 'buftype' denote |special-buffers|
351 'readonly' will be detected automatically
352 'modified' will be detected automatically
353
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000354 *:setl* *:setlocal*
Bram Moolenaar6b915c02020-01-18 15:53:19 +0100355:setl[ocal][!] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000356 current buffer or window. Not all options have a
357 local value. If the option does not have a local
358 value the global value is set.
Bram Moolenaarc3301872010-07-25 20:53:06 +0200359 With the "all" argument: display local values for all
360 local options.
361 Without argument: Display local values for all local
362 options which are different from the default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000363 When displaying a specific local option, show the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000364 local value. For a global/local boolean option, when
365 the global value is being used, "--" is displayed
366 before the option name.
367 For a global option the global value is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000368 shown (but that might change in the future).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000369
Matt Ellis374e26a2024-02-24 17:02:43 +0100370:se[t] {option}< Set the effective value of {option} to its global
zeertzjqd086b8f2024-02-25 15:42:52 +0800371 value.
Matt Ellis374e26a2024-02-24 17:02:43 +0100372 For string |global-local| options, the local value is
373 removed, so that the global value will be used.
374 For all other options, the global value is copied to
375 the local value.
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000376
Matt Ellis374e26a2024-02-24 17:02:43 +0100377:setl[ocal] {option}< Set the effective value of {option} to its global
zeertzjqd086b8f2024-02-25 15:42:52 +0800378 value.
Matt Ellis374e26a2024-02-24 17:02:43 +0100379 For number and boolean |global-local| options, the
380 local value is removed, so that the global value will
381 be used.
382 For all other options, including string |global-local|
383 options, the global value is copied to the local
384 value.
385
386Note that the behaviour for |global-local| options is slightly different
387between string and number-based options.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000388
389 *:setg* *:setglobal*
Bram Moolenaar6b915c02020-01-18 15:53:19 +0100390:setg[lobal][!] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000391 option without changing the local value.
392 When displaying an option, the global value is shown.
Bram Moolenaarc3301872010-07-25 20:53:06 +0200393 With the "all" argument: display global values for all
394 local options.
395 Without argument: display global values for all local
396 options which are different from the default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000397
398For buffer-local and window-local options:
Millyd9af78b2024-09-26 15:54:43 +0200399 Command global value local value condition ~
400 :set option=value set set
401 :setlocal option=value - set
402:setglobal option=value set -
403 :set option? - display local value is set
404 :set option? display - local value is not set
405 :setlocal option? - display
406:setglobal option? display -
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000407
408
409Global options with a local value *global-local*
410
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +0000411Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows.
412For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value.
413You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then
414use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global
415value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000416
417For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global
418'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: >
419 :set makeprg=gmake
420then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set
421the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too.
422However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000423another 'makeprg' for it, without changing the value used for the C source
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000424files. You use this command: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000425 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake
426You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: >
427 :setlocal makeprg=
Bram Moolenaar314dd792019-02-03 15:27:20 +0100428This only works for a string option. For a number or boolean option you need
429to use the "<" flag, like this: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000430 :setlocal autoread<
Bram Moolenaar314dd792019-02-03 15:27:20 +0100431Note that for non-boolean and non-number options using "<" copies the global
432value to the local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value
433(that matters when the global value changes later). You can also use: >
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000434 :set path<
435This will make the local value of 'path' empty, so that the global value is
436used. Thus it does the same as: >
437 :setlocal path=
Bram Moolenaar2f0936c2022-01-08 21:51:59 +0000438Note: In the future more global options can be made |global-local|. Using
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000439":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then.
440
Yegappan Lakshmanan777175b2021-11-18 22:08:57 +0000441 *option-value-function*
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +0100442Some options ('completefunc', 'findfunc', 'imactivatefunc', 'imstatusfunc',
443'omnifunc', 'operatorfunc', 'quickfixtextfunc', 'tagfunc' and 'thesaurusfunc')
444are set to a function name or a function reference or a lambda function. When
445using a lambda it will be converted to the name, e.g. "<lambda>123".
446Examples:
Yegappan Lakshmanan777175b2021-11-18 22:08:57 +0000447>
448 set opfunc=MyOpFunc
Yegappan Lakshmanan19916a82021-11-24 16:32:55 +0000449 set opfunc=function('MyOpFunc')
450 set opfunc=funcref('MyOpFunc')
Yegappan Lakshmanan05e59e32021-12-01 10:30:07 +0000451 set opfunc={a\ ->\ MyOpFunc(a)}
Bram Moolenaar1fca5f32022-02-18 17:50:47 +0000452
453Set to a script-local function: >
454 set opfunc=s:MyLocalFunc
455 set opfunc=<SID>MyLocalFunc
456In |Vim9| script the "s:" and "<SID>" can be omitted if the function exists in
457the script: >
458 set opfunc=MyLocalFunc
459
460Set using a funcref variable: >
Yegappan Lakshmanan05e59e32021-12-01 10:30:07 +0000461 let Fn = function('MyTagFunc')
Bram Moolenaarfa3b7232021-12-24 13:18:38 +0000462 let &tagfunc = Fn
Bram Moolenaar1fca5f32022-02-18 17:50:47 +0000463
464Set using a lambda expression: >
Yegappan Lakshmanan64095532021-12-06 11:03:55 +0000465 let &tagfunc = {t -> MyTagFunc(t)}
Bram Moolenaar1fca5f32022-02-18 17:50:47 +0000466
467Set using a variable with lambda expression: >
Yegappan Lakshmanan05e59e32021-12-01 10:30:07 +0000468 let L = {a, b, c -> MyTagFunc(a, b , c)}
Yegappan Lakshmanan64095532021-12-06 11:03:55 +0000469 let &tagfunc = L
Bram Moolenaar7b1463b2021-12-11 17:24:39 +0000470
471In Vim9 script, in a compiled function, you can use a lambda, but a
Aliaksei Budaveib043ff32023-10-03 17:39:53 +0300472closure does not work, because the function will be called without the
Bram Moolenaar7b1463b2021-12-11 17:24:39 +0000473context of where it was defined.
474
Yegappan Lakshmanan777175b2021-11-18 22:08:57 +0000475
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000476Setting the filetype
477
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +0200478:setf[iletype] [FALLBACK] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000479 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if
480 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands.
481 This is short for: >
482 :if !did_filetype()
483 : setlocal filetype={filetype}
484 :endif
485< This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid
486 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different
487 settings and syntax files to be loaded.
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +0200488
489 When the optional FALLBACK argument is present, a
490 later :setfiletype command will override the
Bram Moolenaar26967612019-03-17 17:13:16 +0100491 'filetype'. This is to be used for filetype
492 detections that are just a guess. |did_filetype()|
493 will return false after this command.
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +0200494
Bram Moolenaard58e9292011-02-09 17:07:58 +0100495 *option-window* *optwin*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000496:bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options*
497:opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options.
498 Options are grouped by function.
499 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the
500 short help to open a help window with more help for
501 the option.
502 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the
503 "set" line to set the new value. For window and
504 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is
505 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help
506 window, in which case the window below help window is
507 used (skipping the option-window).
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +0100508 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
509 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000510
511 *$HOME*
512Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an
513option and after a space or comma.
514
515On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory
516of user "user". Example: >
517 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,.
518
519On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can
520contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the
521"gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'.
522
523NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set"
524command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let".
525
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +0200526 *$HOME-windows*
527On MS-Windows, if $HOME is not defined as an environment variable, then
528at runtime Vim will set it to the expansion of $HOMEDRIVE$HOMEPATH.
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200529If $HOMEDRIVE is not set then $USERPROFILE is used.
530
531This expanded value is not exported to the environment, this matters when
532running an external command: >
533 :echo system('set | findstr ^HOME=')
534and >
535 :echo luaeval('os.getenv("HOME")')
536should echo nothing (an empty string) despite exists('$HOME') being true.
537When setting $HOME to a non-empty string it will be exported to the
538subprocesses.
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +0200539
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000540
541Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on
542the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
543
544 *:fix* *:fixdel*
545:fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD':
546 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~
547 CTRL-? CTRL-H
548 not CTRL-? CTRL-?
549
Bram Moolenaar82be4842021-01-11 19:40:15 +0100550 (CTRL-? is 0o177 octal, 0x7f hex)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000551
552 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the
553 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in
554 your .vimrc: >
555 :fixdel
556< This works no matter what the actual code for
557 backspace is.
558
559 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can
560 use this: >
561 :if &term == "termname"
562 : set t_kb=^V<BS>
563 : fixdel
564 :endif
565< Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000566 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000567 with your terminal name.
568
569 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not
570 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: >
571 :if &term == "termname"
572 : set t_kD=^V<Delete>
573 :endif
574< Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key
575 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname"
576 with your terminal name.
577
578 *Linux-backspace*
579 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key
580 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by
581 putting this line in your rc.local: >
582 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys
583<
584 *NetBSD-backspace*
585 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce
586 the right code, try this: >
587 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace"
588< If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: >
589 keysym 22 = BackSpace
590< You need to restart for this to take effect.
591
592==============================================================================
5932. Automatically setting options *auto-setting*
594
595Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives
596to set options automatically for one or more files:
597
5981. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See
599 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions,
600 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started.
601 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and
602 |:mksession|.
6032. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed.
604 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and
605 many other things. See |autocommand|.
6063. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a
607 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for
608 modelines. This is explained here.
609
610 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520*
611There are two forms of modelines. The first form:
Bram Moolenaar664f3cf2019-12-07 16:03:51 +0100612 [text{white}]{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000613
Bram Moolenaar664f3cf2019-12-07 16:03:51 +0100614[text{white}] empty or any text followed by at least one blank
615 character (<Space> or <Tab>); "ex:" always requires at
616 least one blank character
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200617{vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200618[white] optional white space
619{options} a list of option settings, separated with white space
620 or ':', where each part between ':' is the argument
621 for a ":set" command (can be empty)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000622
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200623Examples:
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000624 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6 ~
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200625 vim: tw=77 ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000626
627The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi):
628
Bram Moolenaarade0d392020-01-21 22:33:58 +0100629 [text{white}]{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text]
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000630
Bram Moolenaarade0d392020-01-21 22:33:58 +0100631[text{white}] empty or any text followed by at least one blank
632 character (<Space> or <Tab>); "ex:" always requires at
633 least one blank character
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200634{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:", "Vim:" or "ex:"
635[white] optional white space
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200636se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space); When
637 "Vim" is used it must be "set".
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200638{options} a list of options, separated with white space, which
639 is the argument for a ":set" command
640: a colon
641[text] any text or empty
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000642
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200643Examples:
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000644 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200645 /* Vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000646
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200647The white space before {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the
648chance that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception:
649"vi:" and "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with
650version 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this
651could be short for "example:").
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000652
Hu Jialun9dcd3492021-08-28 20:42:50 +0200653If the modeline is disabled within a modeline, subsequent modelines will be
654ignored. This is to allow turning off modeline on a per-file basis. This is
655useful when a line looks like a modeline but isn't. For example, it would be
656good to start a YAML file containing strings like "vim:" with
657 # vim: nomodeline ~
658so as to avoid modeline misdetection. Following options on the same line
659after modeline deactivation, if any, are still evaluated (but you would
660normally not have any).
661
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000662 *modeline-local*
663The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +0000664buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global
665options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and
666the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result
667depends on which one was opened last.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000668
Bram Moolenaar15d0a8c2004-09-06 17:44:46 +0000669When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options
670from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local
671option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer
672in another window. But window-local options will be set.
673
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000674 *modeline-version*
675If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200676number can be specified where "vim:" or "Vim:" is used:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000677 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later
678 vim<{vers}: version before {vers}
679 vim={vers}: version {vers}
680 vim>{vers}: version after {vers}
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +0100681{vers} is 700 for Vim 7.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor).
682For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 7.0:
683 /* vim700: set foldmethod=marker */ ~
684To use a modeline for Vim after version 7.2:
685 /* vim>702: set cole=2: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000686There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":".
687
688
689The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option.
690If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked.
691
692Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000693like:
694 /* vi:ts=4: */ ~
695will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK:
696 /* vi:set ts=4: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000697
698If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped.
699
700If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000701backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example:
Bram Moolenaar95a9dd12019-12-19 22:12:03 +0100702 /* vi:set fillchars=stl\:^,vert\:\|: */ ~
703This sets the 'fillchars' option to "stl:^,vert:\|". Only a single backslash
704before the ':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:".
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +0200705 *E992*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000706No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +0000707might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines). And not all options
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +0200708can be set. For some options a flag is set, so that when the value is used
709the |sandbox| is effective. Some options can only be set from the modeline
710when 'modelineexpr' is set (the default is off).
711
712Still, there is always a small risk that a modeline causes trouble. E.g.,
713when some joker sets 'textwidth' to 5 all your lines are wrapped unexpectedly.
714So disable modelines before editing untrusted text. The mail ftplugin does
715this, for example.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000716
717Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could
718define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For
719example: >
720 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif
721And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing
722"VAR".
723
724==============================================================================
7253. Options summary *option-summary*
726
727In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with
728an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used.
729
730In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option"
731is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used.
732
733For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is
734used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when
735'compatible' is set.
736
737Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000738are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000739different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in
740one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view
741at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain
742file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example
743the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C
744program.
745
746 global one option for all buffers and windows
747 local to window each window has its own copy of this option
748 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option
749
750When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window
751are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the
752buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the
753'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for
754buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000755first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer
756is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000757present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the
758buffer is created.
759
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +0000760Hidden options *hidden-options*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000761
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +0000762Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported
763features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces
764below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an
765error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden
766option though, it is not stored.
767
768To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: >
769 if exists('&foo')
770This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really
771supported use something like this: >
772 if exists('+foo')
773<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000774 *E355*
775A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
776
777 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph*
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +0100778'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-Windows, 224 otherwise)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000779 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000780 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
781 feature}
782 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The
783 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode
784 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_)
785 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26].
786 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8.
787 See |rileft.txt|.
788
789 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'*
790'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off)
791 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000792 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
793 feature}
794 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to
795 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get
796 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See
797 'revins'.
798 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
799
800 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'*
801'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off)
802 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000803 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi|
804 feature}
Bram Moolenaar14184a32019-02-16 15:10:30 +0100805 This option was for using Farsi, which has been removed. See
806 |farsi.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000807
808 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'*
809'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single")
810 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000811 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding.
812 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class
813 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek
814 letters, Cyrillic letters).
815
816 There are currently two possible values:
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000817 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000818 expected by most users.
819 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters.
Bram Moolenaar5c3bd0a2010-08-04 20:55:44 +0200820 *E834* *E835*
821 The value "double" cannot be used if 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar079ba762021-10-23 12:08:41 +0100822 contains a character that would be double width. These errors may
823 also be given when calling setcellwidths().
Bram Moolenaar08aac3c2020-08-28 21:04:24 +0200824
825 The values are overruled for characters specified with
826 |setcellwidths()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000827
828 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for
829 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in
830 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro,
831 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000832 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000833 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000834 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000835 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font
836 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.),
837 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived
838 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +0100839 to be set to "double" under CJK MS-Windows when the system locale is
840 set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode Standard Annex #11
841 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000842
Bram Moolenaarac7bd632013-03-19 11:35:58 +0100843 Vim may set this option automatically at startup time when Vim is
844 compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and if |t_u7| is set to the
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200845 escape sequence to request cursor position report. The response can
846 be found in |v:termu7resp|.
Bram Moolenaarac7bd632013-03-19 11:35:58 +0100847
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000848 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'*
849'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off)
850 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000851 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +0200852 on macOS}
853 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on macOS
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000854 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts,
855 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays.
856 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set
857 to its default (empty string).
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +0100858 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000859
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000860 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'*
861'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off)
862 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000863 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
864 feature}
865 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text.
866 Setting this option will:
867 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
868 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
869 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles
870 between typing English and Arabic key mapping.
871 - Set the 'delcombine' option
872 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text.
873
874 Resetting this option will:
875 - Reset the 'rightleft' option.
876 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value).
877 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +0200878 option).
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +0100879 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000880 Also see |arabic.txt|.
881
882 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'*
883 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'*
884'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on)
885 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000886 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
887 feature}
888 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character
889 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +0200890 take effect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000891 one which encompasses:
892 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location
893 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone).
894 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters
895 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +0100896 When disabled the display shows each character's true stand-alone
897 form.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000898 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for
899 further details see |arabic.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +0100900 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000901
laburnumT3f7855a2023-12-05 18:37:03 +0100902 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'*
903'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off)
904 global
905 {only available when compiled with it, use
906 exists("+autochdir") to check}
907 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
908 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window.
909 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened
910 or selected. When a buffer has no name it also has no directory, thus
911 the current directory won't change when navigating to it.
912 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work.
913
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000914 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'*
915'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off)
916 local to buffer
917 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR>
918 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not
919 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000920 <Esc>, CTRL-O or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor
921 to another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included
922 in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000923 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you
924 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first
925 line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000926 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in
927 a different way.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +0200928 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and
929 restored when 'paste' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000930
931 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'*
932'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off)
933 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000934 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and
935 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again.
Bram Moolenaarfd358112018-07-07 23:21:31 +0200936 When the file has been deleted this is not done, so you have the text
937 from before it was deleted. When it appears again then it is read.
938 |timestamp|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000939 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to
940 using the global value: >
941 :set autoread<
942<
laburnumT3f7855a2023-12-05 18:37:03 +0100943
944 *'autoshelldir'* *'asd'* *'noautoshelldir'* *'noasd'*
945'autoshelldir' 'asd' boolean (default off)
946 global
947 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
948 change the directory of the shell running in a terminal window. You
949 need proper setting-up, so whenever the shell's pwd changes an OSC 7
950 escape sequence will be emitted. For example, on Linux, you can
951 source /etc/profile.d/vte.sh in your shell profile if you use bash or
952 zsh. For bash this should work (put it in a bash init file): >
953 if [[ -n "$VIM_TERMINAL" ]]; then
954 PROMPT_COMMAND='_vim_sync_PWD'
955 function _vim_sync_PWD() {
956 printf '\033]7;file://%s\033\\' "$PWD"
957 }
958 fi
959<
960 Or, in a zsh init file: >
961 if [[ -n "$VIM_TERMINAL" ]]; then
962 autoload -Uz add-zsh-hook
963 add-zsh-hook -Uz chpwd _vim_sync_PWD
964 function _vim_sync_PWD() {
965 printf '\033]7;file://%s\033\\' "$PWD"
966 }
967 fi
968<
969 In a fish init file: >
970 if test -n "$VIM_TERMINAL"
971 function _vim_sync_PWD --on-variable=PWD
972 printf '\033]7;file://%s\033\\' "$PWD"
973 end
974 end
975<
976 You can find an alternative method at |terminal-autoshelldir|.
977 When the parsing of the OSC sequence fails you get *E1179* .
978
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000979 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'*
980'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off)
981 global
982 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each
Bram Moolenaar47003982021-12-05 21:54:04 +0000983 `:next`, `:rewind`, `:last`, `:first`, `:previous`, `:stop`,
Bram Moolenaar2f0936c2022-01-08 21:51:59 +0000984 `:suspend`, `:tag`, `:!`, `:make`, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when
985 a `:buffer`, CTRL-O, CTRL-I, '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one
Bram Moolenaar47003982021-12-05 21:54:04 +0000986 to another file.
987 A buffer is not written if it becomes hidden, e.g. when 'bufhidden' is
Bram Moolenaar2f0936c2022-01-08 21:51:59 +0000988 set to "hide" and `:next` is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000989 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see
990 'autowriteall' for that.
Bram Moolenaar93a1df22018-09-10 11:51:50 +0200991 Some buffers will not be written, specifically when 'buftype' is
Bram Moolenaar20aac6c2018-09-02 21:07:30 +0200992 "nowrite", "nofile", "terminal" or "prompt".
Bram Moolenaarb7398fe2023-05-14 18:50:25 +0100993 USE WITH CARE: If you make temporary changes to a buffer that you
994 don't want to be saved this option may cause it to be saved anyway.
995 Renaming the buffer with ":file {name}" may help avoid this.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000996
997 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'*
998'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off)
999 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001000 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit",
1001 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window.
1002 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has
1003 been set.
1004
1005 *'background'* *'bg'*
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +02001006'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light", see below)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001007 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001008 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a
1009 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that
1010 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal.
1011 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used.
1012 This will not always be correct.
1013 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim
1014 what the background color looks like. For changing the background
1015 color, see |:hi-normal|.
1016
Gregory Anders83ad2722024-01-03 19:48:51 +01001017 When 'background' is changed Vim will adjust the default color groups
1018 for the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will
1019 not change. *g:colors_name*
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01001020 When a color scheme is loaded (the "g:colors_name" variable is set)
Gregory Anders83ad2722024-01-03 19:48:51 +01001021 changing 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001022 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work.
1023 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01001024 be undone. First delete the "g:colors_name" variable when needed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001025
1026 When setting 'background' to the default value with: >
1027 :set background&
1028< Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly,
1029 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value.
Bram Moolenaar2e693a82019-10-16 22:35:02 +02001030 If the GUI supports a dark theme, you can use the "d" flag in
Bram Moolenaar50bf7ce2019-09-15 13:17:00 +02001031 'guioptions', see 'go-d'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001032
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +02001033 When the |t_RB| option is set, Vim will use it to request the background
Bram Moolenaarb4d6c3e2017-05-27 16:45:17 +02001034 color from the terminal. If the returned RGB value is dark/light and
1035 'background' is not dark/light, 'background' will be set and the
Jon Parise71028a32025-01-20 20:19:18 +01001036 screen is redrawn. This may have side effects, make |t_RB| empty in
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +02001037 your .vimrc if you suspect this problem. The response to |t_RB| can
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +01001038 be found in |v:termrbgresp|.
Bram Moolenaarb4d6c3e2017-05-27 16:45:17 +02001039
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001040 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be
1041 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects
1042 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to
1043 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read
1044 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background
1045 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by
1046 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value
1047 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on").
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +02001048
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01001049 For MS-Windows the default is "dark".
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +02001050 For other systems "dark" is used when 'term' is "linux",
1051 "screen.linux", "cygwin" or "putty", or $COLORFGBG suggests a dark
1052 background. Otherwise the default is "light".
1053
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +02001054 The |:terminal| command and the |term_start()| function use the
1055 'background' value to decide whether the terminal window will start
1056 with a white or black background.
1057
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001058 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly
1059 depending on the terminal name. Example: >
1060 :if &term == "pcterm"
1061 : set background=dark
1062 :endif
1063< When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups
1064 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER
1065 the setting of the 'background' option.
1066 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file
1067 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this
1068 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be
1069 done with ":syntax on".
1070
1071 *'backspace'* *'bs'*
h-eastb534e802024-12-03 20:37:52 +01001072'backspace' 'bs' string (Vim default: "indent,eol,start",
1073 Vi default: "")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001074 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001075 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert
1076 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows
1077 a way to backspace over something:
1078 value effect ~
1079 indent allow backspacing over autoindent
1080 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines)
1081 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U
1082 stop once at the start of insert.
Bram Moolenaaraa0489e2020-04-17 19:41:21 +02001083 nostop like start, except CTRL-W and CTRL-U do not stop at the start of
1084 insert.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001085
Bram Moolenaar46eea442022-03-30 10:51:39 +01001086 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used, none of
1087 the ways mentioned for the items above are possible.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001088
1089 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier:
1090 value effect ~
1091 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible)
1092 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol"
1093 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start"
Bram Moolenaaraa0489e2020-04-17 19:41:21 +02001094 3 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,nostop"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001095
1096 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want.
1097 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
1098
1099 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'*
1100'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off)
1101 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001102 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the
1103 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the
1104 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being
1105 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is
1106 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001107 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001108 |backup-table| for more explanations.
1109 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
1110 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the
1111 oldest version of a file.
1112 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
1113
1114 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'*
1115'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto")
Bram Moolenaarb8ee25a2014-09-23 15:45:08 +02001116 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001117 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001118 done. This is a comma-separated list of words.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001119
1120 The main values are:
1121 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one
1122 "no" rename the file and write a new one
1123 "auto" one of the previous, what works best
1124
1125 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are:
1126 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing
1127 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing
1128
1129 Making a copy and overwriting the original file:
1130 - Takes extra time to copy the file.
1131 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or
1132 has a resource fork, all this is preserved.
1133 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link,
1134 not of the real file.
1135
1136 Renaming the file and writing a new one:
1137 + It's fast.
1138 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new
1139 file.
1140 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link.
1141
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001142 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming the
1143 file is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on
1144 and the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected,
1145 a copy will be made.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001146
1147 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in
1148 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they
1149 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing
1150 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to
1151 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be
1152 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or
1153 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not
1154 be propagated back to the original source.
Christian Brabandt5bcfb5a2024-10-14 22:08:22 +02001155 *crontab*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001156 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program
1157 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if
1158 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001159 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an
Christian Brabandt5bcfb5a2024-10-14 22:08:22 +02001160 example, as are several |file-watcher| daemons like inotify. In that
1161 case you probably want to switch this option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001162
1163 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled
1164 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001165 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001166 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001167 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this
1168 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for
1169 others.
1170
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001171 When the file is renamed, this is the other way around: The backup has
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001172 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file
1173 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic)
1174 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't
1175 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly
1176 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but
1177 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will
1178 again not rename the file.
1179
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001180 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
1181 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
1182
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001183 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'*
1184'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01001185 for Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:/tmp,c:/temp"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001186 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/")
1187 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001188 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas.
1189 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01001190 where this is possible. The directory must exist, Vim will not
1191 create it for you.
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01001192 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ('patchmode' is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001193 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this.
1194 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory
1195 as the edited file.
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01001196 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-Windows) means to put
1197 the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The leading
1198 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001199 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning).
1200 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
1201 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
1202 name, precede it with a backslash.
1203 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
1204 - A directory name may end in an '/'.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02001205 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//",
Bram Moolenaarf0d58ef2018-11-16 16:13:44 +01001206 the backup file name will be built from the complete path to the
1207 file with all path separators changed to percent '%' signs. This
1208 will ensure file name uniqueness in the backup directory.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02001209 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a
1210 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will
1211 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to
1212 use '//', instead of '\\'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001213 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
1214 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
1215 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
1216 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
1217< - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
1218 of the option is removed.
1219 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options.
1220 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: >
1221 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp
1222< You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your
1223 home directory for this to work properly.
1224 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
1225 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
1226 uses another default.
1227 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1228 security reasons.
1229
1230 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589*
1231'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_")
1232 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001233 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the
1234 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids
1235 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might
1236 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with
1237 ".bak" that you want to keep.
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001238 Only normal file name characters can be used; "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001239
Bram Moolenaar3fdfa4a2004-10-07 21:02:47 +00001240 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre
1241 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to
1242 include a timestamp. >
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00001243 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' .. strftime("%Y%b%d%X") .. '~'
Bram Moolenaar3fdfa4a2004-10-07 21:02:47 +00001244< Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory.
1245
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001246 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'*
Bram Moolenaarb8e22a02018-04-12 21:37:34 +02001247'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*"
1248 Unix: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*"
1249 Mac: "/private/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001250 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001251 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the
1252 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both
1253 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used.
1254 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
1255 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|.
1256 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00001257 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001258
Bram Moolenaar1aeaf8c2012-05-18 13:46:39 +02001259 WARNING: Not having a backup file means that when Vim fails to write
1260 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
1261 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only disable
1262 backups if you don't care about losing the file.
1263
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001264 Note that environment variables are not expanded. If you want to use
1265 $HOME you must expand it explicitly, e.g.: >
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00001266 :let &backupskip = escape(expand('$HOME'), '\') .. '/tmp/*'
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001267
1268< Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00001269 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see
1270 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001271
1272 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'*
1273'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600)
1274 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001275 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
1276 feature}
1277 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|.
1278
1279 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'*
1280'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off)
1281 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001282 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001283 feature}
Bram Moolenaar51b0f372017-11-18 18:52:04 +01001284 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the GUI.
1285
1286 *'balloonevalterm'* *'bevalterm'* *'noballoonevalterm'*
1287 *'nobevalterm'*
1288'balloonevalterm' 'bevalterm' boolean (default off)
1289 global
Bram Moolenaar51b0f372017-11-18 18:52:04 +01001290 {only available when compiled with the
1291 |+balloon_eval_term| feature}
1292 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the terminal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001293
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001294 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'*
1295'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar9b2200a2006-03-20 21:55:45 +00001296 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001297 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
1298 feature}
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00001299 Expression for text to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used
Bram Moolenaara6c27c42019-05-09 19:16:22 +02001300 when 'ballooneval' or 'balloonevalterm' is on. These variables can be
1301 used:
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001302
1303 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show
1304 v:beval_winnr number of the window
Bram Moolenaar82af8712016-06-04 20:20:29 +02001305 v:beval_winid ID of the window
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001306 v:beval_lnum line number
1307 v:beval_col column number (byte index)
1308 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer
1309
Bram Moolenaar54775062019-07-31 21:07:14 +02001310 Instead of showing a balloon, which is limited to plain text, consider
1311 using a popup window, see |popup_beval_example|. A popup window can
1312 use highlighting and show a border.
1313
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001314 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects!
1315 Example: >
Bram Moolenaara6c27c42019-05-09 19:16:22 +02001316 function MyBalloonExpr()
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00001317 return 'Cursor is at line ' .. v:beval_lnum ..
1318 \ ', column ' .. v:beval_col ..
1319 \ ' of file ' .. bufname(v:beval_bufnr) ..
1320 \ ' on word "' .. v:beval_text .. '"'
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001321 endfunction
1322 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr()
Bram Moolenaarf1dcd142022-12-31 15:30:45 +00001323 set ballooneval balloonevalterm
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001324<
Bram Moolenaar396e8292019-07-13 23:04:31 +02001325 Also see |balloon_show()|, it can be used if the content of the balloon
1326 is to be fetched asynchronously. In that case evaluating
1327 'balloonexpr' should result in an empty string. If you get a balloon
1328 with only "0" you probably didn't return anything from your function.
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001329
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001330 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text
1331 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty,
1332 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans
1333 or Sun Workshop).
1334
Yegappan Lakshmanan8bb65f22021-12-26 10:51:39 +00001335 If the expression starts with s: or |<SID>|, then it is replaced with
1336 the script ID (|local-function|). Example: >
1337 set bexpr=s:MyBalloonExpr()
1338 set bexpr=<SID>SomeBalloonExpr()
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00001339< Otherwise, the expression is evaluated in the context of the script
1340 where the option was set, thus script-local items are available.
1341
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001342 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
1343 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02001344 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00001345
1346 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
Bram Moolenaar396e8292019-07-13 23:04:31 +02001347 evaluating 'balloonexpr', see |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00001348
Bram Moolenaar87e25fd2005-07-27 21:13:01 +00001349 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: >
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00001350 if has("balloon_multiline")
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00001351< When they are supported "\n" characters will start a new line. If the
1352 expression evaluates to a |List| this is equal to using each List item
1353 as a string and putting "\n" in between them.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001354 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00001355
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001356 *'belloff'* *'bo'*
1357'belloff' 'bo' string (default "")
1358 global
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001359 Specifies for which events the bell will not be rung. It is a comma
1360 separated list of items. For each item that is present, the bell
1361 will be silenced. This is most useful to specify specific events in
1362 insert mode to be silenced.
LemonBoy77771d32022-04-13 11:47:25 +01001363 You can also make it flash by using 'visualbell'.
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001364
1365 item meaning when present ~
1366 all All events.
1367 backspace When hitting <BS> or <Del> and deleting results in an
1368 error.
1369 cursor Fail to move around using the cursor keys or
1370 <PageUp>/<PageDown> in |Insert-mode|.
1371 complete Error occurred when using |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K| or
1372 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|.
1373 copy Cannot copy char from insert mode using |i_CTRL-Y| or
1374 |i_CTRL-E|.
1375 ctrlg Unknown Char after <C-G> in Insert mode.
1376 error Other Error occurred (e.g. try to join last line)
1377 (mostly used in |Normal-mode| or |Cmdline-mode|).
1378 esc hitting <Esc> in |Normal-mode|.
1379 ex In |Visual-mode|, hitting |Q| results in an error.
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01001380 hangul Ignored.
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001381 insertmode Pressing <Esc> in 'insertmode'.
1382 lang Calling the beep module for Lua/Mzscheme/TCL.
1383 mess No output available for |g<|.
1384 showmatch Error occurred for 'showmatch' function.
1385 operator Empty region error |cpo-E|.
1386 register Unknown register after <C-R> in |Insert-mode|.
1387 shell Bell from shell output |:!|.
1388 spell Error happened on spell suggest.
LemonBoy77771d32022-04-13 11:47:25 +01001389 term Bell from |:terminal| output.
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001390 wildmode More matches in |cmdline-completion| available
1391 (depends on the 'wildmode' setting).
1392
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001393 This is most useful to fine tune when in Insert mode the bell should
1394 be rung. For Normal mode and Ex commands, the bell is often rung to
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001395 indicate that an error occurred. It can be silenced by adding the
1396 "error" keyword.
1397
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001398 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'*
1399'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off)
1400 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001401 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also
1402 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few
1403 options will be changed (also when it already was on):
1404 'textwidth' will be set to 0
1405 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0
1406 'modeline' will be off
1407 'expandtab' will be off
1408 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the
1409 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL>
1410 separates lines).
1411 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the
1412 file is read without conversion.
1413 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is
1414 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g.,
1415 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set
1416 'bin' again when the file has been loaded.
1417 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when
1418 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of
1419 saved option values.
1420 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument.
1421 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all
1422 files you edit.
1423 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if
1424 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to
1425 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See
1426 the 'endofline' option.
1427
1428 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'*
1429'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on)
1430 global
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02001431 {only for MS-DOS}
Bram Moolenaarf3913272016-02-25 00:00:01 +01001432 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001433
1434 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'*
1435'bomb' boolean (default off)
1436 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001437 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte
1438 Order Mark) is prepended to the file:
1439 - this option is on
1440 - the 'binary' option is off
1441 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big
1442 endian variants.
1443 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file.
1444 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it
1445 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2
njohnstonaabca252023-11-19 23:18:57 +00001446 appear halfway through the resulting file. Gcc doesn't accept a BOM.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001447 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a
1448 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly.
1449 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you
1450 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM
1451 will be restored when writing the file.
1452
1453 *'breakat'* *'brk'*
1454'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?")
1455 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02001456 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001457 feature}
1458 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line
Bram Moolenaarac6e65f2005-08-29 22:25:38 +00001459 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit
1460 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001461
Bram Moolenaar7c1c6db2016-04-03 22:08:05 +02001462 *'breakindent'* *'bri'* *'nobreakindent'* *'nobri'*
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001463'breakindent' 'bri' boolean (default off)
1464 local to window
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001465 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
1466 feature}
1467 Every wrapped line will continue visually indented (same amount of
1468 space as the beginning of that line), thus preserving horizontal blocks
1469 of text.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001470 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001471
1472 *'breakindentopt'* *'briopt'*
1473'breakindentopt' 'briopt' string (default empty)
1474 local to window
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001475 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
1476 feature}
1477 Settings for 'breakindent'. It can consist of the following optional
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02001478 items and must be separated by a comma:
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001479 min:{n} Minimum text width that will be kept after
1480 applying 'breakindent', even if the resulting
1481 text should normally be narrower. This prevents
1482 text indented almost to the right window border
Dominique Pellédf62c622024-07-15 20:29:59 +02001483 occupying lots of vertical space when broken.
Christian Brabandtc53b4672022-01-15 10:01:05 +00001484 (default: 20)
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02001485 shift:{n} After applying 'breakindent', the wrapped line's
1486 beginning will be shifted by the given number of
1487 characters. It permits dynamic French paragraph
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001488 indentation (negative) or emphasizing the line
1489 continuation (positive).
Christian Brabandte7d6dbc2022-05-06 12:21:04 +01001490 (default: 0)
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01001491 sbr Display the 'showbreak' value before applying the
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001492 additional indent.
Christian Brabandte7d6dbc2022-05-06 12:21:04 +01001493 (default: off)
Maxim Kimf674b352021-07-22 11:46:59 +02001494 list:{n} Adds an additional indent for lines that match a
Christian Brabandt4a0b85a2021-07-14 20:00:27 +02001495 numbered or bulleted list (using the
1496 'formatlistpat' setting).
Christian Brabandte7d6dbc2022-05-06 12:21:04 +01001497 (default: 0)
zeertzjq61a6ac42024-09-07 11:23:54 +02001498 list:-1 Uses the width of a match with 'formatlistpat' for
1499 indentation.
Christian Brabandte7d6dbc2022-05-06 12:21:04 +01001500 column:{n} Indent at column {n}. Will overrule the other
1501 sub-options. Note: an additional indent may be
1502 added for the 'showbreak' setting.
1503 (default: off)
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001504
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001505 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'*
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00001506'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001507 global
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001508 {only for Motif, GTK, Mac and Win32 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001509 Which directory to use for the file browser:
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001510 last Use same directory as with last file browser, where a
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02001511 file was opened or saved.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001512 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer.
1513 current Use the current directory.
1514 {path} Use the specified directory
1515
1516 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'*
1517'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "")
Christian Brabandt596ad662023-08-16 00:11:09 +02001518 local to buffer |local-noglobal|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001519 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer
1520 displayed in a window:
1521 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001522 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), even if 'hidden' is
1523 not set
1524 unload unload the buffer, even if 'hidden' is set; the
Bram Moolenaar8a3b8052022-06-26 12:21:15 +01001525 |:hide| command will also unload the buffer
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001526 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, even if
1527 'hidden' is set; the |:hide| command will also delete
1528 the buffer, making it behave like |:bdelete|
1529 wipe wipe the buffer from the buffer list, even if
1530 'hidden' is set; the |:hide| command will also wipe
1531 out the buffer, making it behave like |:bwipeout|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001532
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001533 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01001534 are lost without a warning. Also, these values may break autocommands
1535 that switch between buffers temporarily.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001536 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify
1537 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
1538
1539 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85*
1540'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on)
1541 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001542 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If
1543 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc.
1544 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember
1545 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer.
1546 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer".
1547
1548 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382*
1549'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "")
Christian Brabandt596ad662023-08-16 00:11:09 +02001550 local to buffer |local-noglobal|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001551 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer:
1552 <empty> normal buffer
1553 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be
1554 written
1555 nowrite buffer which will not be written
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001556 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01001557 autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001558 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001559 or list of locations |:lwindow|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001560 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this
1561 manually)
Bram Moolenaar1f2903c2017-07-23 19:51:01 +02001562 terminal buffer for a |terminal| (you are not supposed to set
1563 this manually)
Bram Moolenaarf2732452018-06-03 14:47:35 +02001564 prompt buffer where only the last line can be edited, meant
1565 to be used by a plugin, see |prompt-buffer|
1566 {only when compiled with the |+channel| feature}
Bram Moolenaar4d784b22019-05-25 19:51:39 +02001567 popup buffer used in a popup window, see |popup|.
1568 {only when compiled with the |+textprop| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001569
1570 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to
1571 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
Bram Moolenaarebdf3c92020-02-15 21:41:42 +01001572 Also see |win_gettype()|, which returns the type of the window.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001573
1574 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects!
Bram Moolenaar113cb512021-11-07 20:27:04 +00001575 One such effect is that Vim will not check the timestamp of the file,
1576 if the file is changed by another program this will not be noticed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001577
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001578 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location
1579 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and
1580 you are not supposed to change it.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001581
1582 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar:
1583 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't
1584 work (":w filename" does work though).
1585 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|.
1586 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for
1587 example when you quit Vim.
1588 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory
1589 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap
1590 file).
1591 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a
1592 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd|
1593 command.
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +01001594 both: When using ":e bufname" and already editing "bufname"
1595 the buffer is made empty and autocommands are
1596 triggered as usual for |:edit|.
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001597 *E676*
1598 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like
1599 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and
1600 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned
1601 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|,
1602 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001603
1604 *'casemap'* *'cmp'*
1605'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii")
1606 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001607 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain
1608 these words, separated by a comma:
1609 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current
1610 locale does not change the case mapping. This only
Bram Moolenaar6f16eb82005-08-23 21:02:42 +00001611 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding,
1612 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is
1613 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library
1614 functions are used when available.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001615 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US
1616 case mapping, the current locale is not effective.
1617 This probably only matters for Turkish.
1618
Bram Moolenaar938ae282023-02-20 20:44:55 +00001619 *'cdhome'* *'cdh'* *'nocdhome'* *'nocdh'*
Bram Moolenaar7b1463b2021-12-11 17:24:39 +00001620'cdhome' 'cdh' boolean (default: off)
1621 global
1622 When on, |:cd|, |:tcd| and |:lcd| without an argument changes the
1623 current working directory to the |$HOME| directory like in Unix.
1624 When off, those commands just print the current directory name.
1625 On Unix this option has no effect.
dkearns8ebdbc92023-10-29 06:26:19 +11001626 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1627 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar7b1463b2021-12-11 17:24:39 +00001628 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
1629
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001630 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346*
1631'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,")
1632 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001633 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
Bram Moolenaar00aa0692019-04-27 20:37:57 +02001634 |:cd|, |:tcd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being
1635 searched for has a relative path, not an absolute part starting with
1636 "/", "./" or "../", the 'cdpath' option is not used then.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001637 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as
1638 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|.
1639 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look
1640 in the current directory first.
1641 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include
1642 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to
1643 override it: >
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00001644 :let &cdpath = ',' .. substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g')
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001645< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1646 security reasons.
1647 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names).
1648
1649 *'cedit'*
1650'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F)
1651 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001652 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window.
1653 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off.
1654 Only non-printable keys are allowed.
1655 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to
Milly25732432024-10-01 19:30:20 +02001656 type. The preferred way is to use |key-notation| (e.g. <Up>, <C-F>) or
1657 a letter preceded with a caret (e.g. `^F` is CTRL-F). Examples: >
1658 :set cedit=^Y
1659 :set cedit=<Esc>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001660< |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character.
1661 See |cmdwin|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001662 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
1663 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001664
1665 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513*
1666'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "")
1667 global
Bram Moolenaar4c92e752019-02-17 21:18:32 +01001668 {only available when compiled with the |+eval| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001669 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is
1670 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a
1671 different encoding from what is desired.
1672 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is
1673 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is
1674 preferred, because it is much faster.
1675 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no
1676 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first.
Bram Moolenaarf10911e2022-01-29 22:20:48 +00001677 The expression must return zero, false or an empty string for success,
1678 non-zero or true for failure.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001679 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'.
1680 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are
1681 used.
1682 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8"
1683 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this.
1684 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c'
1685 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion.
1686 Example: >
1687 set charconvert=CharConvert()
1688 fun CharConvert()
1689 system("recode "
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00001690 \ .. v:charconvert_from .. ".." .. v:charconvert_to
1691 \ .. " <" .. v:fname_in .. " >" .. v:fname_out)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001692 return v:shell_error
1693 endfun
1694< The related Vim variables are:
1695 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding
1696 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding
1697 v:fname_in name of the input file
1698 v:fname_out name of the output file
1699 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same.
1700 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different
1701 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4.
Bram Moolenaarf10911e2022-01-29 22:20:48 +00001702
Bram Moolenaara4e0b972022-10-01 19:43:52 +01001703 The advantage of using a function call without arguments is that it is
1704 faster, see |expr-option-function|.
1705
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001706 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want
1707 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care
1708 of this.
Bram Moolenaarf10911e2022-01-29 22:20:48 +00001709
1710 If the 'charconvert' expression starts with s: or |<SID>|, then it is
1711 replaced with the script ID (|local-function|). Example: >
1712 set charconvert=s:MyConvert()
1713 set charconvert=<SID>SomeConvert()
1714< Otherwise the expression is evaluated in the context of the script
1715 where the option was set, thus script-local items are available.
1716
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001717 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1718 security reasons.
1719
64-bitman88d41ab2025-04-06 17:20:39 +02001720 *'chistory'* *'chi'*
1721'chistory' 'chi' number (default: 10)
1722 global
1723 {only available when compiled with the |+quickfix|
1724 feature}
1725 Number of quickfix lists that should be remembered for the quickfix
1726 stack. Must be between 1 and 100. If the option is set to a value
1727 that is lower than the amount of entries in the quickfix list stack,
1728 entries will be removed starting from the oldest one. If the current
1729 quickfix list was removed, then the quickfix list at top of the stack
1730 (the most recently created) will be used in its place. For additional
1731 info, see |quickfix-stack|.
1732
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001733 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'*
1734'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off)
1735 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001736 Enables automatic C program indenting. See 'cinkeys' to set the keys
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001737 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your
1738 preferred indent style.
1739 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'.
1740 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty,
1741 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an
1742 external program.
1743 See |C-indenting|.
1744 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent'
1745 option or 'indentexpr'.
1746 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
1747 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
1748
1749 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'*
Bram Moolenaarce655742019-01-31 14:12:57 +01001750'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),0],:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001751 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001752 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
1753 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is
1754 empty.
1755 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|.
1756 See |C-indenting|.
1757
1758 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'*
1759'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "")
1760 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001761 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C
1762 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and
1763 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general.
1764
laburnumT3f7855a2023-12-05 18:37:03 +01001765 *'cinscopedecls'* *'cinsd'*
1766'cinscopedecls' 'cinsd' string (default "public,protected,private")
1767 local to buffer
1768 Keywords that are interpreted as a C++ scope declaration by |cino-g|.
1769 Useful e.g. for working with the Qt framework that defines additional
1770 scope declarations "signals", "public slots" and "private slots": >
1771 set cinscopedecls+=signals,public\ slots,private\ slots
1772<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001773 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'*
1774'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch")
1775 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001776 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when
1777 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at
1778 an appropriate place (inside {}).
1779 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't
1780 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase:
1781 "if,If,IF".
1782
laburnumT3f7855a2023-12-05 18:37:03 +01001783 *'clipboard'* *'cb'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001784'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux"
1785 for X-windows, "" otherwise)
1786 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001787 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard|
1788 feature is included}
Tom Praschan3506cf32022-04-07 12:39:08 +01001789 This option is a list of comma-separated names.
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01001790 Note: if one of the items is "exclude:", then you can't add an item
Bram Moolenaar5ed11532022-07-06 13:18:11 +01001791 after that. Therefore do not append an item with += but use ^= to
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01001792 prepend, e.g.: >
1793 set clipboard^=unnamed
Bram Moolenaar9fbdbb82022-09-27 17:30:34 +01001794< When using the GUI see |'go-A'|.
1795 These names are recognized:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001796
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001797 *clipboard-unnamed*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001798 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*'
1799 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which
1800 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a
1801 register is explicitly specified, it will always be
1802 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard'
1803 or not. The clipboard register can always be
1804 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see
1805 |gui-clipboard|.
1806
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001807 *clipboard-unnamedplus*
Bram Moolenaar00154502013-02-13 16:15:55 +01001808 unnamedplus A variant of the "unnamed" flag which uses the
1809 clipboard register '+' (|quoteplus|) instead of
1810 register '*' for all yank, delete, change and put
1811 operations which would normally go to the unnamed
1812 register. When "unnamed" is also included to the
1813 option, yank operations (but not delete, change or
1814 put) will additionally copy the text into register
1815 '*'.
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01001816 Only available with the |+X11| feature.
Bram Moolenaarbf9680e2010-12-02 21:43:16 +01001817 Availability can be checked with: >
1818 if has('unnamedplus')
1819<
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001820 *clipboard-autoselect*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001821 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present,
1822 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual
1823 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the
1824 windowing system's global selection or put the
1825 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection
Bram Moolenaarba3ff532018-11-04 14:45:49 +01001826 register "*. See |'go-a'| and |quotestar| for details.
1827 When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in 'guioptions'
1828 is used, when the GUI is not active, this "autoselect"
1829 flag is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001830 Also applies to the modeless selection.
1831
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001832 *clipboard-autoselectplus*
1833 autoselectplus Like "autoselect" but using the + register instead of
1834 the * register. Compare to the 'P' flag in
1835 'guioptions'.
1836
1837 *clipboard-autoselectml*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001838 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection
1839 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'.
1840
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001841 *clipboard-html*
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001842 html When the clipboard contains HTML, use this when
1843 pasting. When putting text on the clipboard, mark it
1844 as HTML. This works to copy rendered HTML from
1845 Firefox, paste it as raw HTML in Vim, select the HTML
1846 in Vim and paste it in a rich edit box in Firefox.
Bram Moolenaar20a825a2010-05-31 21:27:30 +02001847 You probably want to add this only temporarily,
1848 possibly use BufEnter autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001849 Only supported for GTK version 2 and later.
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001850
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001851 *clipboard-exclude*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001852 exclude:{pattern}
1853 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of
1854 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no
1855 connection will be made to the X server. This is
1856 useful in this situation:
1857 - Running Vim in a console.
1858 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another
1859 display.
1860 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the
1861 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator.
1862 To never connect to the X server use: >
1863 exclude:.*
1864< This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument.
1865 Note that when there is no connection to the X server
1866 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard
1867 cannot be accessed.
1868 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is
1869 interpreted as if 'magic' was on.
1870 The rest of the option value will be used for
1871 {pattern}, this must be the last entry.
1872
1873 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'*
1874'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1)
Shougo Matsushitaf39cfb72022-07-30 16:54:05 +01001875 global or local to tab page
Bram Moolenaara2a89732022-08-31 14:46:18 +01001876 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. A larger value
1877 helps avoiding |hit-enter| prompts.
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001878 The value of this option is stored with the tab page, so that each tab
1879 page can have a different value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001880
1881 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'*
1882'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7)
1883 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001884 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin|
1885
Bram Moolenaar483c5d82010-10-20 18:45:33 +02001886 *'colorcolumn'* *'cc'*
1887'colorcolumn' 'cc' string (default "")
1888 local to window
Bram Moolenaar483c5d82010-10-20 18:45:33 +02001889 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
1890 feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001891 'colorcolumn' is a comma-separated list of screen columns that are
Bram Moolenaar483c5d82010-10-20 18:45:33 +02001892 highlighted with ColorColumn |hl-ColorColumn|. Useful to align
1893 text. Will make screen redrawing slower.
1894 The screen column can be an absolute number, or a number preceded with
1895 '+' or '-', which is added to or subtracted from 'textwidth'. >
1896
Bram Moolenaar10e8ff92023-06-10 21:40:39 +01001897 :set cc=+1 " highlight column after 'textwidth'
Bram Moolenaar483c5d82010-10-20 18:45:33 +02001898 :set cc=+1,+2,+3 " highlight three columns after 'textwidth'
1899 :hi ColorColumn ctermbg=lightgrey guibg=lightgrey
1900<
1901 When 'textwidth' is zero then the items with '-' and '+' are not used.
1902 A maximum of 256 columns are highlighted.
1903
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001904 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594*
1905'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width)
1906 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001907 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00001908 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see
1909 |posix-screen-size|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001910 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
1911 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
1912 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
1913 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001914 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up. For
1915 the GUI it is always possible and Vim limits the number of columns to
1916 what fits on the screen. You can use this command to get the widest
1917 window possible: >
1918 :set columns=9999
1919< Minimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001920
1921 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525*
1922'comments' 'com' string (default
1923 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-")
1924 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001925 A comma-separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001926 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to
1927 insert a space.
1928
1929 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537*
Riley Bruins0a083062024-06-03 20:40:45 +02001930'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/* %s */")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001931 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001932 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
1933 feature}
1934 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the
Riley Bruins0a083062024-06-03 20:40:45 +02001935 comment text, and should be padded with a space when possible.
h-east84ac2122024-06-17 18:12:30 +02001936 Currently used to add markers for folding, see |fold-marker|. Also
Riley Bruins0a083062024-06-03 20:40:45 +02001937 commonly used by commenting plugins (e.g. |comment-install|).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001938
1939 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'*
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001940'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc|
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02001941 file is found, reset in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001942 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001943 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or
1944 make Vim behave in a more useful way.
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001945
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001946 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset,
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001947 other options are also changed as a side effect.
1948 NOTE: Setting or resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected
1949 effects: Mappings are interpreted in another way, undo behaves
1950 differently, etc. If you set this option in your vimrc file, you
1951 should probably put it at the very start.
1952
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001953 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the
1954 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim
1955 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible'
1956 option.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001957 When a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file is found while Vim is starting up,
Bram Moolenaard042c562005-06-30 22:04:15 +00001958 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been
1959 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001960 that when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file exists, Vim will use the Vim
Bram Moolenaard042c562005-06-30 22:04:15 +00001961 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001962 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file, nor for a file given
1963 with the |-u| argument). Also see |compatible-default| and
1964 |posix-compliance|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001965 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with
1966 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|.
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001967 See 'cpoptions' for more fine tuning of Vi compatibility.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001968
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001969 When this option is set, numerous other options are set to make Vim as
1970 Vi-compatible as possible. When this option is unset, various options
1971 are set to make Vim more useful. The table below lists all the
1972 options affected.
1973 The {?} column indicates when the options are affected:
1974 + Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when
1975 'compatible' is set.
1976 & Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when
1977 'compatible' is set AND is set to its Vim default value when
1978 'compatible' is unset.
1979 - Means the option is NOT changed when setting 'compatible' but IS
1980 set to its Vim default when 'compatible' is unset.
1981 The {effect} column summarises the change when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001982
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001983 option ? set value effect ~
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001984
1985 'allowrevins' + off no CTRL-_ command
1986 'antialias' + off don't use antialiased fonts
Bram Moolenaarbe4e0162023-02-02 13:59:48 +00001987 'arabic' + off reset arabic-related options
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001988 'arabicshape' + on correct character shapes
1989 'backspace' + "" normal backspace
1990 'backup' + off no backup file
1991 'backupcopy' & Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy
1992 else: "auto" copy or rename backup file
1993 'balloonexpr' + "" text to show in evaluation balloon
1994 'breakindent' + off don't indent when wrapping lines
1995 'cedit' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
Bram Moolenaar7b1463b2021-12-11 17:24:39 +00001996 'cdhome' + off ":cd" don't chdir to home on non-Unix
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001997 'cindent' + off no C code indentation
1998 'compatible' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
1999 'copyindent' + off don't copy indent structure
2000 'cpoptions' & (all flags) Vi-compatible flags
2001 'cscopepathcomp'+ 0 don't show directories in tags list
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01002002 'cscoperelative'+ off don't use basename of path as prefix
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01002003 'cscopetag' + off don't use cscope for ":tag"
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002004 'cscopetagorder'+ 0 see |cscopetagorder|
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01002005 'cscopeverbose' + off see |cscopeverbose|
2006 'delcombine' + off unicode: delete whole char combination
2007 'digraph' + off no digraphs
2008 'esckeys' & off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode
Christian Brabandt5f5131d2023-10-25 21:44:26 +02002009 this also disables |modifyOtherKeys|
2010 and |xterm-bracketed-paste|
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01002011 'expandtab' + off tabs not expanded to spaces
2012 'fileformats' & "" no automatic file format detection,
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01002013 "dos,unix" except for MS-Windows
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01002014 'formatexpr' + "" use 'formatprg' for auto-formatting
2015 'formatoptions' & "vt" Vi compatible formatting
2016 'gdefault' + off no default 'g' flag for ":s"
2017 'history' & 0 no commandline history
2018 'hkmap' + off no Hebrew keyboard mapping
2019 'hkmapp' + off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping
2020 'hlsearch' + off no highlighting of search matches
2021 'incsearch' + off no incremental searching
2022 'indentexpr' + "" no indenting by expression
2023 'insertmode' + off do not start in Insert mode
2024 'iskeyword' & "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002025 characters and '_'
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01002026 'joinspaces' + on insert 2 spaces after period
2027 'modeline' & off no modelines
2028 'more' & off no pauses in listings
2029 'mzquantum' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
2030 'numberwidth' & 8 min number of columns for line number
2031 'preserveindent'+ off don't preserve current indent structure
2032 when changing it
2033 'revins' + off no reverse insert
2034 'ruler' + off no ruler
2035 'scrolljump' + 1 no jump scroll
2036 'scrolloff' + 0 no scroll offset
2037 'shelltemp' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
2038 'shiftround' + off indent not rounded to shiftwidth
Bram Moolenaar9dfa3132019-05-04 21:08:40 +02002039 'shortmess' & "S" no shortening of messages
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01002040 'showcmd' & off command characters not shown
2041 'showmode' & off current mode not shown
2042 'sidescrolloff' + 0 cursor moves to edge of screen in scroll
2043 'smartcase' + off no automatic ignore case switch
2044 'smartindent' + off no smart indentation
2045 'smarttab' + off no smart tab size
2046 'softtabstop' + 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions
2047 'startofline' + on goto startofline with some commands
2048 'tagcase' & "followic" 'ignorecase' when searching tags file
2049 'tagrelative' & off tag file names are not relative
2050 'termguicolors' + off don't use highlight-(guifg|guibg)
2051 'textauto' & off no automatic textmode detection
2052 'textwidth' + 0 no automatic line wrap
2053 'tildeop' + off tilde is not an operator
2054 'ttimeout' + off no terminal timeout
2055 'undofile' + off don't use an undo file
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002056 'viminfo' - {unchanged} {set Vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01002057 'virtualedit' + "" cursor can only be placed on characters
2058 'whichwrap' & "" left-right movements don't wrap
2059 'wildchar' & CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002060 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01002061 'writebackup' + on or off depends on the |+writebackup| feature
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002062
2063 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535*
2064'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i")
2065 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002066 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works
2067 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line
2068 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01002069 and the places to scan. It is a comma-separated list of flags:
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01002070 . scan the current buffer ('wrapscan' is ignored)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002071 w scan buffers from other windows
2072 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list
2073 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list
2074 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list
2075 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00002076 kspell use the currently active spell checking |spell|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002077 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given,
2078 patterns are valid too. For example: >
2079 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish
2080< s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option
2081 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns
2082 are valid too.
2083 i scan current and included files
2084 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro
2085 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D|
2086 ] tag completion
2087 t same as "]"
Girish Palya14f6da52025-05-26 19:04:25 +02002088 F{func} call the function {func}. Multiple "F" flags may be specified.
Girish Palyacbe53192025-04-14 22:13:15 +02002089 Refer to |complete-functions| for details on how the function
2090 is invoked and what it should return. The value can be the
2091 name of a function or a |Funcref|. For |Funcref| values,
2092 spaces must be escaped with a backslash ('\'), and commas with
2093 double backslashes ('\\') (see |option-backslash|).
2094 If the Dict returned by the {func} includes {"refresh": "always"},
2095 the function will be invoked again whenever the leading text
2096 changes.
2097 Completion matches are always inserted at the keyword
2098 boundary, regardless of the column returned by {func} when
2099 a:findstart is 1. This ensures compatibility with other
2100 completion sources.
2101 To make further modifications to the inserted text, {func}
2102 can make use of |CompleteDonePre|.
2103 If generating matches is potentially slow, |complete_check()|
2104 should be used to avoid blocking and preserve editor
2105 responsiveness.
Girish Palya14f6da52025-05-26 19:04:25 +02002106 F equivalent to using "F{func}", where the function is taken from
Girish Palyacbe53192025-04-14 22:13:15 +02002107 the 'completefunc' option.
Girish Palya14f6da52025-05-26 19:04:25 +02002108 o equivalent to using "F{func}", where the function is taken from
Girish Palyacbe53192025-04-14 22:13:15 +02002109 the 'omnifunc' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002110
2111 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are
2112 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files
2113 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for
2114 whole-line completion.
2115
2116 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan:
2117 1. the current buffer
2118 2. buffers in other windows
2119 3. other loaded buffers
2120 4. unloaded buffers
2121 5. tags
2122 6. included files
2123
2124 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'-
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00002125 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns
2126 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002127
Girish Palya0ac1eb32025-04-16 20:18:33 +02002128 An optional match limit can be specified for a completion source by
2129 appending a caret ("^") followed by a {count} to the source flag.
2130 For example: ".^9,w,u,t^5" limits matches from the current buffer
Hirohito Higashifa8b7db2025-04-30 19:12:37 +02002131 to 9 and from tags to 5. Other sources remain unlimited.
2132 Note: The match limit takes effect only during forward completion
2133 (CTRL-N) and is ignored during backward completion (CTRL-P).
Girish Palya0ac1eb32025-04-16 20:18:33 +02002134
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00002135 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'*
2136'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty)
2137 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02002138 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
Bram Moolenaare2c453d2019-08-21 14:37:09 +02002139 feature}
Bram Moolenaarc7486e02005-12-29 22:48:26 +00002140 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion
2141 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00002142 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
Yegappan Lakshmanan8658c752021-12-03 11:09:29 +00002143 invoked and what it should return. The value can be the name of a
2144 function, a |lambda| or a |Funcref|. See |option-value-function| for
2145 more information.
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01002146 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2147 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00002148
glepnirf31cfa22025-03-06 21:59:13 +01002149 *'completefuzzycollect'* *'cfc'*
2150'completefuzzycollect' 'cfc' string (default: empty)
2151 global
zeertzjq1dc731a2025-03-13 21:30:10 +01002152 A comma-separated list of strings to enable fuzzy collection for
2153 specific |ins-completion| modes, affecting how matches are gathered
2154 during completion. For specified modes, fuzzy matching is used to
2155 find completion candidates instead of the standard prefix-based
2156 matching. This option can contain the following values:
glepnir53b14572025-03-12 21:28:39 +01002157
glepnir58760162025-03-13 21:39:51 +01002158 keyword keywords in the current file |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-N|
2159 keywords with flags ".", "w", |i_CTRL-N| |i_CTRL-P|
2160 "b", "u", "U" and "k{dict}" in 'complete'
2161 keywords in 'dictionary' |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|
glepnir53b14572025-03-12 21:28:39 +01002162
glepnir58760162025-03-13 21:39:51 +01002163 files file names |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-F|
glepnir53b14572025-03-12 21:28:39 +01002164
glepnir58760162025-03-13 21:39:51 +01002165 whole_line whole lines |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|
glepnir53b14572025-03-12 21:28:39 +01002166
Christian Brabandtf22580e2025-03-14 12:05:52 +01002167 When using the 'completeopt' "longest" option value, fuzzy collection
glepnir58760162025-03-13 21:39:51 +01002168 can identify the longest common string among the best fuzzy matches
2169 and insert it automatically.
glepnirf31cfa22025-03-06 21:59:13 +01002170
glepnir6a89c942024-10-01 20:32:12 +02002171 *'completeitemalign'* *'cia'*
2172'completeitemalign' 'cia' string (default: "abbr,kind,menu")
2173 global
zeertzjq85a50fe2025-02-27 19:24:32 +01002174 A comma-separated list of strings that controls the alignment and
2175 display order of items in the popup menu during Insert mode
2176 completion. The supported values are "abbr", "kind", and "menu".
2177 These values allow customizing how |complete-items| are shown in the
glepnir6a89c942024-10-01 20:32:12 +02002178 popup menu. Note: must always contain those three values in any
2179 order.
2180
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00002181 *'completeopt'* *'cot'*
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00002182'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu,preview")
zeertzjq529b9ad2024-06-05 20:27:06 +02002183 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01002184 A comma-separated list of options for Insert mode completion
Bram Moolenaarc7453f52006-02-10 23:20:28 +00002185 |ins-completion|. The supported values are:
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00002186
glepnira2c55592025-02-28 17:43:42 +01002187 fuzzy Enable |fuzzy-matching| for completion candidates. This
2188 allows for more flexible and intuitive matching, where
2189 characters can be skipped and matches can be found even
zeertzjq53d59ec2025-03-07 19:09:09 +01002190 if the exact sequence is not typed. Note: This option
glepnirf31cfa22025-03-06 21:59:13 +01002191 does not affect the collection of candidate list, it only
2192 controls how completion candidates are reduced from the
zeertzjq53d59ec2025-03-07 19:09:09 +01002193 list of alternatives. If you want to use |fuzzy-matching|
glepnirf31cfa22025-03-06 21:59:13 +01002194 to gather more alternatives for your candidate list,
2195 see |'completefuzzycollect'|.
glepnira2c55592025-02-28 17:43:42 +01002196
2197 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. If
2198 the menu is displayed you can use CTRL-L to add more
2199 characters. Whether case is ignored depends on the kind
2200 of completion. For buffer text the 'ignorecase' option is
2201 used.
2202
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00002203 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The
2204 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and
2205 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu|
2206
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00002207 menuone Use the popup menu also when there is only one match.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002208 Useful when there is additional information about the
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00002209 match, e.g., what file it comes from.
2210
Girish Palyacb3b7522025-04-18 18:52:28 +02002211 nearest Matches are listed based on their proximity to the cursor
2212 position, unlike the default behavior, which only
2213 considers proximity for matches appearing below the
2214 cursor. This applies only to matches from the current
Girish Palyab1565882025-04-15 20:16:00 +02002215 buffer. No effect if "fuzzy" is present.
2216
glepnira2c55592025-02-28 17:43:42 +01002217 noinsert Do not insert any text for a match until the user selects
zeertzjq659cb282025-03-03 20:18:04 +01002218 a match from the menu. Only works in combination with
2219 "menu" or "menuone". No effect if "longest" is present.
Bram Moolenaarc7453f52006-02-10 23:20:28 +00002220
glepnira2c55592025-02-28 17:43:42 +01002221 noselect Same as "noinsert", except that no menu item is
zeertzjq659cb282025-03-03 20:18:04 +01002222 pre-selected. If both "noinsert" and "noselect" are
glepnira2c55592025-02-28 17:43:42 +01002223 present, "noselect" has precedence.
2224
2225 nosort Disable sorting of completion candidates based on fuzzy
zeertzjq659cb282025-03-03 20:18:04 +01002226 scores when "fuzzy" is enabled. Candidates will appear
glepnira2c55592025-02-28 17:43:42 +01002227 in their original order.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00002228
Bram Moolenaar576a4a62019-08-18 15:25:17 +02002229 popup Show extra information about the currently selected
2230 completion in a popup window. Only works in combination
2231 with "menu" or "menuone". Overrides "preview".
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02002232 See |'completepopup'| for specifying properties.
Bram Moolenaar2e693a82019-10-16 22:35:02 +02002233 {only works when compiled with the |+textprop| feature}
Bram Moolenaar576a4a62019-08-18 15:25:17 +02002234
Bram Moolenaardca7abe2019-10-20 18:17:57 +02002235 popuphidden
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01002236 Just like "popup" but initially hide the popup. Use a
Bram Moolenaardca7abe2019-10-20 18:17:57 +02002237 |CompleteChanged| autocommand to fetch the info and call
2238 |popup_show()| once the popup has been filled.
2239 See the example at |complete-popuphidden|.
2240 {only works when compiled with the |+textprop| feature}
2241
glepniredd4ac32025-01-29 18:53:51 +01002242 preinsert
2243 Preinsert the portion of the first candidate word that is
2244 not part of the current completion leader and using the
glepnir94a045e2025-03-01 16:12:23 +01002245 |hl-ComplMatchIns| highlight group. In order for it to
zeertzjq659cb282025-03-03 20:18:04 +01002246 work, "fuzzy" must not be set and "menuone" must be set.
glepnira2c55592025-02-28 17:43:42 +01002247
2248 preview Show extra information about the currently selected
2249 completion in the preview window. Only works in
2250 combination with "menu" or "menuone".
glepniredd4ac32025-01-29 18:53:51 +01002251
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02002252 *'completepopup'* *'cpp'*
2253'completepopup' 'cpp' string (default empty)
2254 global
2255 {not available when compiled without the |+textprop|
2256 or |+quickfix| feature}
2257 When 'completeopt' contains "popup" then this option is used for the
Bram Moolenaar447bfba2020-07-18 16:07:16 +02002258 properties of the info popup when it is created. If an info popup
2259 window already exists it is closed, so that the option value is
2260 applied when it is created again.
2261 You can also use |popup_findinfo()| and then set properties for an
2262 existing info popup with |popup_setoptions()|. See |complete-popup|.
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02002263
laburnumT3f7855a2023-12-05 18:37:03 +01002264 *'completeslash'* *'csl'*
2265'completeslash' 'csl' string (default: "")
2266 local to buffer
2267 {only for MS-Windows}
2268 When this option is set it overrules 'shellslash' for completion:
2269 - When this option is set to "slash", a forward slash is used for path
2270 completion in insert mode. This is useful when editing HTML tag, or
2271 Makefile with 'noshellslash' on MS-Windows.
2272 - When this option is set to "backslash", backslash is used. This is
2273 useful when editing a batch file with 'shellslash' set on MS-Windows.
2274 - When this option is empty, same character is used as for
2275 'shellslash'.
2276 For Insert mode completion the buffer-local value is used. For
2277 command line completion the global value is used.
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02002278
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002279 *'concealcursor'* *'cocu'*
2280'concealcursor' 'cocu' string (default: "")
2281 local to window
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002282 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
2283 feature}
2284 Sets the modes in which text in the cursor line can also be concealed.
2285 When the current mode is listed then concealing happens just like in
2286 other lines.
2287 n Normal mode
2288 v Visual mode
2289 i Insert mode
Bram Moolenaarca8c9862010-07-24 15:00:38 +02002290 c Command line editing, for 'incsearch'
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002291
Bram Moolenaare6dc5732010-07-24 23:52:26 +02002292 'v' applies to all lines in the Visual area, not only the cursor.
Bram Moolenaarca8c9862010-07-24 15:00:38 +02002293 A useful value is "nc". This is used in help files. So long as you
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002294 are moving around text is concealed, but when starting to insert text
2295 or selecting a Visual area the concealed text is displayed, so that
2296 you can see what you are doing.
Bram Moolenaarf70e3d62010-07-24 13:15:07 +02002297 Keep in mind that the cursor position is not always where it's
2298 displayed. E.g., when moving vertically it may change column.
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002299
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02002300 *'conceallevel'* *'cole'*
2301'conceallevel' 'cole' number (default 0)
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002302 local to window
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002303 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
2304 feature}
Bram Moolenaar6df6f472010-07-18 18:04:50 +02002305 Determine how text with the "conceal" syntax attribute |:syn-conceal|
2306 is shown:
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002307
Bram Moolenaar6df6f472010-07-18 18:04:50 +02002308 Value Effect ~
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002309 0 Text is shown normally
Bram Moolenaar477db062010-07-28 18:17:41 +02002310 1 Each block of concealed text is replaced with one
2311 character. If the syntax item does not have a custom
2312 replacement character defined (see |:syn-cchar|) the
2313 character defined in 'listchars' is used (default is a
2314 space).
2315 It is highlighted with the "Conceal" highlight group.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002316 2 Concealed text is completely hidden unless it has a
2317 custom replacement character defined (see
Bram Moolenaar477db062010-07-28 18:17:41 +02002318 |:syn-cchar|).
Bram Moolenaara7781e02010-07-19 20:13:22 +02002319 3 Concealed text is completely hidden.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002320
Bram Moolenaara7781e02010-07-19 20:13:22 +02002321 Note: in the cursor line concealed text is not hidden, so that you can
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002322 edit and copy the text. This can be changed with the 'concealcursor'
2323 option.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002324
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002325 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'*
2326'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off)
2327 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002328 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally
2329 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e",
2330 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current
2331 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer.
2332 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one
2333 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm|
2334 command.
2335 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'.
2336
2337 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'*
2338'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off)
2339 global
Bram Moolenaarf3913272016-02-25 00:00:01 +01002340 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002341
2342 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'*
2343'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off)
2344 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002345 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a
2346 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of
2347 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled,
2348 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the
2349 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00002350 existing line. 'expandtab' has no effect on these characters, a Tab
2351 remains a Tab. If the new indent is greater than on the existing
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002352 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002353 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002354 Also see 'preserveindent'.
2355
Bram Moolenaare0fa3742016-02-20 15:47:01 +01002356 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'* *cpo*
Illia Bobyr03d20aa2024-07-16 20:10:16 +02002357'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFsz",
2358 Vi default: all flags, except "#{|&/\."
h-east90e1fe42024-08-12 18:26:08 +02002359 |$VIM_POSIX|: all flags)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002360 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002361 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present
Bram Moolenaar7cba6c02013-09-05 22:13:31 +02002362 this indicates Vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where
2363 not being Vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002364 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options".
2365 Commas can be added for readability.
2366 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
2367 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
Bram Moolenaar71eb3ad2021-12-26 12:07:30 +00002368
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002369 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
2370 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar71eb3ad2021-12-26 12:07:30 +00002371
2372 NOTE: In a |Vim9| script, when `vim9script` is encountered, the value
2373 is saved, 'cpoptions' is set to the Vim default, and the saved value
2374 is restored at the end of the script. Changes to the value of
2375 'cpoptions' will be applied to the saved value, but keep in mind that
2376 removing a flag that is not present when 'cpoptions' is changed has no
2377 effect. In the |.vimrc| file the value is not restored, thus using
2378 `vim9script` in the |.vimrc| file results in using the Vim default.
2379
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002380 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when
2381 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002382 variable exists |posix|. This means Vim tries to behave like the
2383 POSIX specification.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002384
2385 contains behavior ~
2386 *cpo-a*
2387 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name
2388 argument will set the alternate file name for the
2389 current window.
2390 *cpo-A*
2391 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name
2392 argument will set the alternate file name for the
2393 current window.
2394 *cpo-b*
2395 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of
2396 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping,
2397 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next
2398 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to
2399 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all
2400 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands.
2401 See also |map_bar|.
2402 *cpo-B*
2403 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings,
Bram Moolenaara9604e62018-07-21 05:56:22 +02002404 abbreviations, user commands and the "to" part of the
2405 menu commands. Remove this flag to be able to use a
2406 backslash like a CTRL-V. For example, the command
2407 ":map X \<Esc>" results in X being mapped to:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002408 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>)
2409 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters)
2410 ('<' excluded in both cases)
2411 *cpo-c*
2412 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the
2413 cursor position, but not further than the start of the
2414 next line. When not present searching continues
2415 one character from the cursor position. With 'c'
2416 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating
2417 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches.
2418 *cpo-C*
2419 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a
2420 backslash. See |line-continuation|.
2421 *cpo-d*
2422 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use
2423 the tags file relative to the current file, but the
2424 tags file in the current directory.
2425 *cpo-D*
2426 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode
2427 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and
2428 |t|.
2429 *cpo-e*
2430 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a
2431 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not
2432 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register
2433 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a
2434 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line
2435 and can be edited before hitting <CR>.
2436 *cpo-E*
2437 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or
2438 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when
Bram Moolenaar15142e22018-04-30 22:19:58 +02002439 at least one character is to be operated on. Example:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002440 This makes "y0" fail in the first column.
2441 *cpo-f*
2442 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name
2443 argument will set the file name for the current buffer,
2444 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet.
2445 *cpo-F*
2446 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name
2447 argument will set the file name for the current
2448 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00002449 yet. Also see |cpo-P|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002450 *cpo-g*
2451 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002452 *cpo-H*
2453 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert
2454 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after
2455 the last blank.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002456 *cpo-i*
2457 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will
2458 leave it modified.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002459 *cpo-I*
2460 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting
2461 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002462 *cpo-j*
2463 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.',
2464 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'.
2465 *cpo-J*
2466 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00002467 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002468 white space.
2469 *cpo-k*
2470 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in
2471 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu
2472 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[
2473 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X
2474 being mapped to:
2475 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters)
2476 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code)
2477 Also see the '<' flag below.
2478 *cpo-K*
2479 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is
2480 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when
2481 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It
2482 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>.
2483 *cpo-l*
2484 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002485 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special.
2486 See |/[]|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002487 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't'
2488 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab>
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002489 Also see |cpo-\|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002490 *cpo-L*
2491 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin',
2492 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode
2493 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of
2494 the normal behavior of a <Tab>.
2495 *cpo-m*
2496 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a
2497 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half
2498 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'|
2499 *cpo-M*
2500 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into
2501 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer
2502 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores
2503 backslashes, which is Vi compatible.
2504 *cpo-n*
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02002505 n When included, the column used for 'number' and
2506 'relativenumber' will also be used for text of wrapped
2507 lines.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002508 *cpo-o*
2509 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for
2510 next search.
2511 *cpo-O*
2512 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even
2513 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a
2514 protection against a file unexpectedly created by
2515 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this.
2516 *cpo-p*
2517 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a
2518 slightly better algorithm is used.
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00002519 *cpo-P*
2520 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a
2521 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if
2522 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and
2523 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002524 *cpo-q*
2525 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the
2526 position where it would be when joining two lines.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002527 *cpo-r*
2528 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search
2529 command, instead of the actually used search string.
2530 *cpo-R*
2531 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag
2532 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used.
2533 *cpo-s*
2534 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the
2535 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002536 And it is the default. If not present the options are
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002537 set when the buffer is created.
2538 *cpo-S*
2539 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer
2540 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and
2541 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting.
2542 The options are set to the values in the current
2543 buffer. When you change an option and go to another
2544 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the
2545 buffer options global to all buffers.
2546
2547 's' 'S' copy buffer options
2548 no no when buffer created
2549 yes no when buffer first entered (default)
2550 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.)
2551 *cpo-t*
2552 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for
2553 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in
2554 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the
2555 last used search pattern.
2556 *cpo-u*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002557 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002558 *cpo-v*
2559 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in
2560 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are
2561 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the
2562 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced
2563 characters.
2564 *cpo-w*
2565 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one
2566 character and not all blanks until the start of the
2567 next word.
2568 *cpo-W*
2569 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!"
2570 overwrites a readonly file, if possible.
2571 *cpo-x*
2572 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line.
2573 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line,
2574 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>|
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002575 *cpo-X*
2576 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is
2577 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "."
2578 and a count.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002579 *cpo-y*
Bram Moolenaard09091d2019-01-17 16:07:22 +01002580 y A yank command can be redone with ".". Think twice if
2581 you really want to use this, it may break some
2582 plugins, since most people expect "." to only repeat a
2583 change.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002584 *cpo-Z*
2585 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set,
2586 don't reset 'readonly'.
Christian Brabandt22105fd2024-07-15 20:51:11 +02002587 *cpo-z*
2588 z Special casing the "cw" and "d" command (see |cw| and
2589 |d-special|).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002590 *cpo-!*
2591 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used
2592 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last
2593 used -filter- command is used.
2594 *cpo-$*
2595 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the
2596 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text.
2597 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the
2598 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any
2599 command that moves the cursor from the insertion
2600 point.
2601 *cpo-%*
2602 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command.
2603 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc.
2604 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/".
2605 Parens inside single and double quotes are also
2606 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to
2607 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like
2608 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not
2609 match the last one. When this flag is not included,
2610 parens inside single and double quotes are treated
2611 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes,
2612 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a
2613 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002614 there is one). This works very well for C programs.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00002615 This flag is also used for other features, such as
2616 C-indenting.
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00002617 *cpo--*
2618 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when
Bram Moolenaar8ada17c2006-01-19 22:16:24 +00002619 it would go above the first line or below the last
2620 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or
2621 last line, unless it already was in that line.
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00002622 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j",
Bram Moolenaar8ada17c2006-01-19 22:16:24 +00002623 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234".
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002624 *cpo-+*
2625 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the
2626 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer
2627 itself may still be different from its file.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002628 *cpo-star*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002629 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included,
2630 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area.
2631 *cpo-<*
2632 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>|
2633 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002634 menu commands. For example, the command
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002635 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to:
2636 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters)
2637 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>)
2638 Also see the 'k' flag above.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002639 *cpo->*
2640 > When appending to a register, put a line break before
2641 the appended text.
Bram Moolenaar8b3e0332011-06-26 05:36:34 +02002642 *cpo-;*
2643 ; When using |,| or |;| to repeat the last |t| search
2644 and the cursor is right in front of the searched
2645 character, the cursor won't move. When not included,
2646 the cursor would skip over it and jump to the
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +02002647 following occurrence.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002648
2649 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except
2650 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix|
2651
2652 contains behavior ~
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002653 *cpo-#*
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002654 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002655 *cpo-&*
2656 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when
2657 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded.
2658 This flag is tested when exiting.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002659 *cpo-\*
2660 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
2661 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]|
Bram Moolenaar90915b52005-08-21 22:17:52 +00002662 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-'
2663 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-'
2664 Also see |cpo-l|.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002665 *cpo-/*
2666 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s|
2667 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%|
2668 *cpo-{*
2669 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character
2670 at the start of a line.
2671 *cpo-.*
2672 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current
2673 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't
2674 need this, since it remembers the full path of an
2675 opened file.
2676 *cpo-bar*
2677 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment
2678 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained
2679 with system specific functions.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002680
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002681 *'cryptmethod'* *'cm'*
Bram Moolenaara86187b2018-12-16 18:20:00 +01002682'cryptmethod' 'cm' string (default "blowfish2")
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002683 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002684 Method used for encryption when the buffer is written to a file:
Bram Moolenaar0bbabe82010-05-17 20:32:55 +02002685 *pkzip*
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002686 zip PkZip compatible method. A weak kind of encryption.
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002687 Backwards compatible with Vim 7.2 and older.
Christian Brabandtaae58342023-04-23 17:50:22 +01002688 Only use if you need to be backwards compatible.
Bram Moolenaar0bbabe82010-05-17 20:32:55 +02002689 *blowfish*
Bram Moolenaar8f4ac012014-08-10 13:38:34 +02002690 blowfish Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption but it has
2691 an implementation flaw. Requires Vim 7.3 or later,
2692 files can NOT be read by Vim 7.2 and older. This adds
2693 a "seed" to the file, every time you write the file
2694 the encrypted bytes will be different.
Christian Brabandtaae58342023-04-23 17:50:22 +01002695 Obsolete, please do no longer use.
Bram Moolenaar8f4ac012014-08-10 13:38:34 +02002696 *blowfish2*
2697 blowfish2 Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption. Requires
Bram Moolenaar5e9b2fa2016-02-01 22:37:05 +01002698 Vim 7.4.401 or later, files can NOT be read by Vim 7.3
Bram Moolenaar8f4ac012014-08-10 13:38:34 +02002699 and older. This adds a "seed" to the file, every time
2700 you write the file the encrypted bytes will be
2701 different. The whole undo file is encrypted, not just
2702 the pieces of text.
Bram Moolenaara2baa732022-02-04 16:09:54 +00002703 *E1193* *E1194* *E1195* *E1196* *E1230*
Christian Brabandtf573c6e2021-06-20 14:02:16 +02002704 *E1197* *E1198* *E1199* *E1200* *E1201*
2705 xchacha20 XChaCha20 Cipher with Poly1305 Message Authentication
clach042afdb3a2025-04-06 17:37:12 +02002706 Code. Medium strong to strong encryption.
Christian Brabandtf573c6e2021-06-20 14:02:16 +02002707 Encryption is provided by the libsodium library, it
Bram Moolenaar22863042021-10-16 15:23:36 +01002708 requires Vim to be built with |+sodium|.
Christian Brabandtf573c6e2021-06-20 14:02:16 +02002709 It adds a seed and a message authentication code (MAC)
2710 to the file. This needs at least a Vim 8.2.3022 to
2711 read the encrypted file.
2712 Encryption of swap files is not supported, therefore
2713 no swap file will be used when xchacha20 encryption is
2714 enabled.
2715 Encryption of undo files is not yet supported,
2716 therefore no undo file will currently be written.
Christian Brabandtaae58342023-04-23 17:50:22 +01002717 CAREFUL: Files written with this method might have to
2718 be read back with the same version of Vim if the
2719 binary format changes later.
2720 Obsolete, please do no longer use.
2721 xchacha20v2 Same algorithm as with "xchacha20" that correctly
2722 stores the key derivation parameters together with the
2723 encrypted file. Should work better in case the
2724 parameters in the libsodium library ever change.
2725 STILL EXPERIMENTAL: Files written with this method
Christian Brabandtf573c6e2021-06-20 14:02:16 +02002726 might have to be read back with the same version of
2727 Vim if the binary format changes later.
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002728
Christian Brabandtaae58342023-04-23 17:50:22 +01002729 You should use "blowfish2", also to re-encrypt older files. The
2730 "xchacha20" method provides better encryption, but it does not work
2731 with all versions of Vim.
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01002732
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002733 When reading an encrypted file 'cryptmethod' will be set automatically
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002734 to the detected method of the file being read. Thus if you write it
2735 without changing 'cryptmethod' the same method will be used.
2736 Changing 'cryptmethod' does not mark the file as modified, you have to
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002737 explicitly write it, you don't get a warning unless there are other
2738 modifications. Also see |:X|.
2739
2740 When setting the global value to an empty string, it will end up with
Bram Moolenaara86187b2018-12-16 18:20:00 +01002741 the value "blowfish2". When setting the local value to an empty
2742 string the buffer will use the global value.
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002743
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002744 When a new encryption method is added in a later version of Vim, and
2745 the current version does not recognize it, you will get *E821* .
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002746 You need to edit this file with the later version of Vim.
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002747
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002748 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'*
2749'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0)
2750 global
2751 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2752 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002753 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags.
2754 See |cscopepathcomp|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002755 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002756
2757 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'*
2758'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope")
2759 global
2760 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2761 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002762 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|.
2763 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2764 security reasons.
2765
2766 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'*
2767'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "")
2768 global
2769 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2770 or |+quickfix| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002771 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results.
2772 See |cscopequickfix|.
2773
Bram Moolenaarec7944a2013-06-12 21:29:15 +02002774 *'cscoperelative'* *'csre'* *'nocscoperelative'* *'nocsre'*
Bram Moolenaar2f982e42011-06-12 20:42:22 +02002775'cscoperelative' 'csre' boolean (default off)
2776 global
2777 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2778 feature}
Bram Moolenaar2f982e42011-06-12 20:42:22 +02002779 In the absence of a prefix (-P) for cscope. setting this option enables
2780 to use the basename of cscope.out path as the prefix.
2781 See |cscoperelative|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002782 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar2f982e42011-06-12 20:42:22 +02002783
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002784 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'*
2785'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off)
2786 global
2787 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2788 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002789 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|.
2790 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2791
2792 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'*
2793'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0)
2794 global
2795 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2796 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002797 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See
2798 |cscopetagorder|.
2799 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
2800
2801 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'*
2802 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'*
2803'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off)
2804 global
2805 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2806 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002807 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|.
2808 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2809
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002810 *'cursorbind'* *'crb'* *'nocursorbind'* *'nocrb'*
2811'cursorbind' 'crb' boolean (default off)
2812 local to window
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002813 When this option is set, as the cursor in the current
2814 window moves other cursorbound windows (windows that also have
2815 this option set) move their cursors to the corresponding line and
2816 column. This option is useful for viewing the
2817 differences between two versions of a file (see 'diff'); in diff mode,
2818 inserted and deleted lines (though not characters within a line) are
Bram Moolenaar1a384422010-07-14 19:53:30 +02002819 taken into account.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002820
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002821 *'cursorcolumn'* *'cuc'* *'nocursorcolumn'* *'nocuc'*
2822'cursorcolumn' 'cuc' boolean (default off)
2823 local to window
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02002824 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002825 feature}
2826 Highlight the screen column of the cursor with CursorColumn
2827 |hl-CursorColumn|. Useful to align text. Will make screen redrawing
2828 slower.
Bram Moolenaar4c3f5362006-04-11 21:38:50 +00002829 If you only want the highlighting in the current window you can use
2830 these autocommands: >
2831 au WinLeave * set nocursorline nocursorcolumn
2832 au WinEnter * set cursorline cursorcolumn
2833<
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002834
2835 *'cursorline'* *'cul'* *'nocursorline'* *'nocul'*
2836'cursorline' 'cul' boolean (default off)
2837 local to window
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02002838 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002839 feature}
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002840 Highlight the text line of the cursor with CursorLine |hl-CursorLine|.
2841 Useful to easily spot the cursor. Will make screen redrawing slower.
Bram Moolenaare2f98b92006-03-29 21:18:24 +00002842 When Visual mode is active the highlighting isn't used to make it
Bram Moolenaar779b74b2006-04-10 14:55:34 +00002843 easier to see the selected text.
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002844
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002845 *'cursorlineopt'* *'culopt'*
Bram Moolenaar017ba072019-09-14 21:01:23 +02002846'cursorlineopt' 'culopt' string (default: "number,line")
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002847 local to window
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002848 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
2849 feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01002850 Comma-separated list of settings for how 'cursorline' is displayed.
Bram Moolenaar017ba072019-09-14 21:01:23 +02002851 Valid values:
2852 "line" Highlight the text line of the cursor with
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002853 CursorLine |hl-CursorLine|.
Bram Moolenaar017ba072019-09-14 21:01:23 +02002854 "screenline" Highlight only the screen line of the cursor with
2855 CursorLine |hl-CursorLine|.
2856 "number" Highlight the line number of the cursor with
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002857 CursorLineNr |hl-CursorLineNr|.
Bram Moolenaar017ba072019-09-14 21:01:23 +02002858
2859 Special value:
2860 "both" Alias for the values "line,number".
2861
2862 "line" and "screenline" cannot be used together.
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002863
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002864 *'debug'*
2865'debug' string (default "")
2866 global
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00002867 These values can be used:
2868 msg Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
2869 anyway.
2870 throw Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
2871 anyway and also throw an exception and set |v:errmsg|.
2872 beep A message will be given when otherwise only a beep would be
2873 produced.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002874 The values can be combined, separated by a comma.
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00002875 "msg" and "throw" are useful for debugging 'foldexpr', 'formatexpr' or
2876 'indentexpr'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002877
2878 *'define'* *'def'*
2879'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define")
2880 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002881 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002882 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the
2883 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is
2884 used to recognize the defined name after the match:
2885 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char}
2886 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space
2887 or backslash.
2888 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be
2889 useful, to include const type declarations: >
2890 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\)
Bram Moolenaar63b74a82019-03-24 15:09:13 +01002891< You can also use "\ze" just before the name and continue the pattern
2892 to check what is following. E.g. for Javascript, if a function is
2893 defined with "func_name = function(args)": >
2894 ^\s*\ze\i\+\s*=\s*function(
2895< If the function is defined with "func_name : function() {...": >
2896 ^\s*\ze\i\+\s*[:]\s*(*function\s*(
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002897< When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes!
Bram Moolenaar63b74a82019-03-24 15:09:13 +01002898 To avoid that use `:let` with a single quote string: >
2899 let &l:define = '^\s*\ze\k\+\s*=\s*function('
Bram Moolenaar911ead12019-04-21 00:03:35 +02002900<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002901
2902 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'*
2903'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off)
2904 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002905 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode
2906 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the
2907 default) the character along with its combining characters are
2908 deleted.
Bram Moolenaar4f4d51a2020-10-11 13:57:40 +02002909 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work differently from "2x"!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002910
2911 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one
2912 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want
2913 to remove only the combining ones.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002914 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002915
2916 *'dictionary'* *'dict'*
2917'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "")
2918 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002919 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
2920 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should
2921 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several
2922 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is
2923 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes.
Bram Moolenaar259f26a2018-05-15 22:25:40 +02002924
2925 When this option is empty or an entry "spell" is present, and spell
2926 checking is enabled, words in the word lists for the currently active
2927 'spelllang' are used. See |spell|.
2928
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002929 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002930 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
2931 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00002932 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002933 Where to find a list of words?
2934 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words".
2935 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory.
2936 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection.
2937 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
2938 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
2939 uses another default.
2940 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
2941
2942 *'diff'* *'nodiff'*
2943'diff' boolean (default off)
2944 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002945 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2946 feature}
2947 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002948 between files. See |vimdiff|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002949
2950 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'*
2951'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "")
2952 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002953 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2954 feature}
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02002955 Expression which is evaluated to obtain a diff file (either ed-style
2956 or unified-style) from two versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002957 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2958 security reasons.
2959
2960 *'dip'* *'diffopt'*
Yee Cheng Chin9943d472025-03-26 19:41:02 +01002961'diffopt' 'dip' string (default
2962 "internal,filler,closeoff,inline:simple")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002963 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002964 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2965 feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002966 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002967 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma.
2968
Jonathon7c7a4e62025-01-12 09:58:00 +01002969 algorithm:{text} Use the specified diff algorithm with the
2970 internal diff engine. Currently supported
2971 algorithms are:
2972 myers the default algorithm
2973 minimal spend extra time to generate the
2974 smallest possible diff
2975 patience patience diff algorithm
2976 histogram histogram diff algorithm
2977
2978 closeoff When a window is closed where 'diff' is set
2979 and there is only one window remaining in the
2980 same tab page with 'diff' set, execute
2981 `:diffoff` in that window. This undoes a
2982 `:diffsplit` command.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002983
2984 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change
2985 and a fold that contains unchanged lines.
2986 When omitted a context of six lines is used.
Bram Moolenaarf6b40102019-02-22 15:24:03 +01002987 When using zero the context is actually one,
2988 since folds require a line in between, also
dundargoc20f48d52023-10-02 21:49:23 +02002989 for a deleted line. Set it to a very large
2990 value (999999) to disable folding completely.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002991 See |fold-diff|.
2992
Jonathon7c7a4e62025-01-12 09:58:00 +01002993 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text
2994 synchronized with a window that has inserted
2995 lines at the same position. Mostly useful
2996 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind'
2997 is set.
2998
2999 foldcolumn:{n} Set the 'foldcolumn' option to {n} when
3000 starting diff mode. Without this 2 is used.
3001
3002 followwrap Follow the 'wrap' option and leave as it is.
3003
3004 horizontal Start diff mode with horizontal splits (unless
3005 explicitly specified otherwise).
3006
3007 hiddenoff Do not use diff mode for a buffer when it
3008 becomes hidden.
3009
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02003010 iblank Ignore changes where lines are all blank. Adds
3011 the "-B" flag to the "diff" command if
3012 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
3013 of the "diff" command for what this does
3014 exactly.
3015 NOTE: the diff windows will get out of sync,
3016 because no differences between blank lines are
3017 taken into account.
3018
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003019 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A"
3020 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag
3021 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty.
3022
Jonathon7c7a4e62025-01-12 09:58:00 +01003023 indent-heuristic
3024 Use the indent heuristic for the internal
3025 diff library.
3026
Yee Cheng Chin9943d472025-03-26 19:41:02 +01003027 inline:{text} Highlight inline differences within a change.
3028 See |view-diffs|. Supported values are:
3029
3030 none Do not perform inline highlighting.
3031 simple Highlight from first different
3032 character to the last one in each
zeertzjq5a307c32025-03-28 19:01:32 +01003033 line. This is the default if no
3034 `inline:` value is set.
Yee Cheng Chin9943d472025-03-26 19:41:02 +01003035 char Use internal diff to perform a
3036 character-wise diff and highlight the
3037 difference.
3038 word Use internal diff to perform a
3039 |word|-wise diff and highlight the
Yee Cheng Chin9aa120f2025-04-04 19:16:21 +02003040 difference. Non-alphanumeric
3041 multi-byte characters such as emoji
3042 and CJK characters are considered
3043 individual words.
Yee Cheng Chin9943d472025-03-26 19:41:02 +01003044
Jonathon7c7a4e62025-01-12 09:58:00 +01003045 internal Use the internal diff library. This is
3046 ignored when 'diffexpr' is set. *E960*
3047 When running out of memory when writing a
3048 buffer this item will be ignored for diffs
3049 involving that buffer. Set the 'verbose'
3050 option to see when this happens.
3051
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003052 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds
3053 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if
3054 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
3055 of the "diff" command for what this does
3056 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing
3057 white space, but not leading white space.
3058
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02003059 iwhiteall Ignore all white space changes. Adds
3060 the "-w" flag to the "diff" command if
3061 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
3062 of the "diff" command for what this does
3063 exactly.
3064
3065 iwhiteeol Ignore white space changes at end of line.
3066 Adds the "-Z" flag to the "diff" command if
3067 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
3068 of the "diff" command for what this does
3069 exactly.
3070
Jonathon7c7a4e62025-01-12 09:58:00 +01003071 linematch:{n} Align and mark changes between the most
3072 similar lines between the buffers. When the
3073 total number of lines in the diff hunk exceeds
3074 {n}, the lines will not be aligned because for
3075 very large diff hunks there will be a
3076 noticeable lag. A reasonable setting is
3077 "linematch:60", as this will enable alignment
3078 for a 2 buffer diff hunk of 30 lines each,
3079 or a 3 buffer diff hunk of 20 lines each.
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00003080
3081 vertical Start diff mode with vertical splits (unless
3082 explicitly specified otherwise).
3083
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02003084 Examples: >
3085 :set diffopt=internal,filler,context:4
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003086 :set diffopt=
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02003087 :set diffopt=internal,filler,foldcolumn:3
3088 :set diffopt-=internal " do NOT use the internal diff parser
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003089<
3090 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'*
3091'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off)
3092 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003093 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs|
3094 feature}
3095 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS>
3096 {char2}. See |digraphs|.
3097 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3098
3099 *'directory'* *'dir'*
3100'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01003101 for Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:\tmp,c:\temp"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003102 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp")
3103 global
3104 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaare7b1ea02020-08-07 19:54:59 +02003105 Recommended value: ".,~/vimswap//" - this will put the swap file next
3106 to the edited file if possible, and in your personal swap directory
3107 otherwise. Make sure "~/vimswap//" is only readable for you.
3108
3109 Possible items:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003110 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is
3111 possible.
3112 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is
Bram Moolenaar00e192b2019-10-19 17:01:28 +02003113 impossible!) and no |E303| error will be given.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003114 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as
3115 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so
3116 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden"
3117 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible.
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01003118 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-Windows) means to put
3119 the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading "."
3120 is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02003121 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//",
3122 the swap file name will be built from the complete path to the file
Bram Moolenaar207f0092020-08-30 17:20:20 +02003123 with all path separators replaced by percent '%' signs (including
3124 the colon following the drive letter on Win32). This will ensure
3125 file name uniqueness in the preserve directory.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02003126 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a
3127 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will
3128 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to
3129 use '//', instead of '\\'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003130 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
3131 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
3132 name, precede it with a backslash.
3133 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
3134 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'.
3135 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3136 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
3137 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
3138 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
3139< - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
3140 of the option is removed.
3141 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing
3142 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is
3143 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file.
3144 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better
Bram Moolenaare7b1ea02020-08-07 19:54:59 +02003145 choice than "/tmp". But others on the computer may be able to see the
3146 files, and it can contain a lot of files, your swap files get lost in
3147 the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your home directory is
3148 tried first.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003149 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
3150 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
3151 uses another default.
3152 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3153 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003154
3155 *'display'* *'dy'*
Bram Moolenaarbc8801c2016-08-02 21:04:33 +02003156'display' 'dy' string (default "", set to "truncate" in
3157 |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003158 global
Bram Moolenaarf269eab2022-10-03 18:04:35 +01003159 Change the way text is displayed. This is a comma-separated list of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003160 flags:
3161 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line
Bram Moolenaarad9c2a02016-07-27 23:26:04 +02003162 in a window will be displayed. "@@@" is put in the
3163 last columns of the last screen line to indicate the
3164 rest of the line is not displayed.
3165 truncate Like "lastline", but "@@@" is displayed in the first
3166 column of the last screen line. Overrules "lastline".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003167 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx>
3168 instead of using ^C and ~C.
3169
Bram Moolenaard0796902016-09-16 20:02:31 +02003170 When neither "lastline" nor "truncate" is included, a last line that
Bram Moolenaarad9c2a02016-07-27 23:26:04 +02003171 doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines.
3172
Bram Moolenaar4ba5f1d2022-10-04 14:36:29 +01003173 The "@" character can be changed by setting the "lastline" item in
3174 'fillchars'. The character is highlighted with |hl-NonText|.
3175
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003176 *'eadirection'* *'ead'*
3177'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both")
3178 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003179 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies:
3180 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected
3181 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected
3182 both width and height of windows is affected
3183
3184 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'*
3185'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off)
3186 global
3187 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be
3188 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See
3189 also 'gdefault' option.
Bram Moolenaarb4d6c3e2017-05-27 16:45:17 +02003190 Switching this option on may break plugins!
Bram Moolenaar4072ba52020-12-23 13:56:35 +01003191 This option is not used in |Vim9| script.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003192
Bram Moolenaar03413f42016-04-12 21:07:15 +02003193 *'emoji'* *'emo'* *'noemoji'* *'noemo'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01003194'emoji' 'emo' boolean (default: on)
3195 global
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01003196 When on all Unicode emoji characters are considered to be full width.
Bram Moolenaar1d59aa12020-09-19 18:50:13 +02003197 This excludes "text emoji" characters, which are normally displayed as
3198 single width. Unfortunately there is no good specification for this
3199 and it has been determined on trial-and-error basis. Use the
3200 |setcellwidths()| function to change the behavior.
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01003201
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003202 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543*
K.Takataf883d902021-05-30 18:04:19 +02003203'encoding' 'enc' string (default for MS-Windows: "utf-8",
3204 otherwise: value from $LANG or "latin1")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003205 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003206 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in
3207 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the
3208 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work
3209 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values.
3210
3211 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00003212 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003213 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003214 starts up. See |multibyte|. To reload the menus see |:menutrans|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003215
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003216 This option cannot be set from a |modeline|. It would most likely
3217 corrupt the text.
3218
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01003219 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 or later, it is highly recommended to set 'encoding'
3220 to "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003221 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and
3222 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003223 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003224 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files
3225 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty).
3226
3227 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003228 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003229 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'.
3230
Bram Moolenaar207f0092020-08-30 17:20:20 +02003231 If you need to know whether 'encoding' is a multibyte encoding, you
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003232 can use: >
3233 if has("multi_byte_encoding")
3234<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003235 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will
3236 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If
3237 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be
3238 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|.
3239
3240 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand
3241 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary.
3242
3243 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3244 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated
3245 to '-' signs.
3246 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name.
3247 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes
3248 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8".
3249
3250 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected.
3251 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the
3252 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and
3253 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using
3254 utf-8.
3255
3256 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8.
3257 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the
3258 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus
3259 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has
3260 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty.
3261
Bram Moolenaar661b1822005-07-28 22:36:45 +00003262 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was
3263 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003264
Bram Moolenaar6ebe4f92022-10-28 20:47:54 +01003265 *'endoffile'* *'eof'* *'noendoffile'* *'noeof'*
Bram Moolenaar0aad88f2022-11-12 11:54:26 +00003266'endoffile' 'eof' boolean (default off)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003267 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar6ebe4f92022-10-28 20:47:54 +01003268 Indicates that a CTRL-Z character was found at the end of the file
3269 when reading it. Normally only happens when 'fileformat' is "dos".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003270 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option
Bram Moolenaar6ebe4f92022-10-28 20:47:54 +01003271 is on, or 'fixeol' option is off, no CTRL-Z will be written at the
Bram Moolenaarfb0cf232022-10-22 11:25:19 +01003272 end of the file.
K.Takata3af98212022-11-01 20:36:19 +00003273 See |eol-and-eof| for example settings.
Bram Moolenaarfb0cf232022-10-22 11:25:19 +01003274
3275 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'*
3276'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on)
3277 local to buffer
3278 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02003279 is on, or 'fixeol' option is off, no <EOL> will be written for the
3280 last line in the file. This option is automatically set or reset when
3281 starting to edit a new file, depending on whether file has an <EOL>
3282 for the last line in the file. Normally you don't have to set or
3283 reset this option.
3284 When 'binary' is off and 'fixeol' is on the value is not used when
3285 writing the file. When 'binary' is on or 'fixeol' is off it is used
3286 to remember the presence of a <EOL> for the last line in the file, so
3287 that when you write the file the situation from the original file can
3288 be kept. But you can change it if you want to.
K.Takata3af98212022-11-01 20:36:19 +00003289 See |eol-and-eof| for example settings.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003290
3291 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'*
3292'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on)
3293 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003294 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after
Bram Moolenaar009b2592004-10-24 19:18:58 +00003295 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the
3296 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the
3297 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When
3298 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it
3299 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright').
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003300 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size
3301 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The
3302 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected.
Bram Moolenaar67f71312007-08-12 14:55:56 +00003303 Changing the height and width of a window can be avoided by setting
3304 'winfixheight' and 'winfixwidth', respectively.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003305 If a window size is specified when creating a new window sizes are
3306 currently not equalized (it's complicated, but may be implemented in
3307 the future).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003308
3309 *'equalprg'* *'ep'*
3310'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "")
3311 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003312 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00003313 the internal formatting functions are used; either 'lisp', 'cindent'
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003314 or 'indentexpr'. When Vim was compiled without internal formatting,
3315 the "indent" program is used.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003316 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003317 about including spaces and backslashes.
3318 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3319 security reasons.
3320
3321 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'*
3322'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off)
3323 global
3324 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only
3325 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always
3326 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003327 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep,
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02003328 screen flash or do nothing. See 'belloff' to finetune when to ring the
3329 bell.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003330
3331 *'errorfile'* *'ef'*
3332'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err",
3333 others: "errors.err")
3334 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003335 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3336 feature}
3337 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|).
3338 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the
3339 following argument. See |-q|.
3340 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that.
3341 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3342 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3343 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3344 security reasons.
3345
3346 *'errorformat'* *'efm'*
3347'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long)
3348 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003349 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3350 feature}
3351 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file
3352 (see |errorformat|).
3353
3354 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'*
3355'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3356 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003357 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert
3358 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be
3359 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of
3360 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of
3361 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to
3362 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that
3363 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys
3364 won't work by default.
3365 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3366 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Christian Brabandt5f5131d2023-10-25 21:44:26 +02003367 NOTE: when this option is off then the |modifyOtherKeys| and
3368 |xterm-bracketed-paste| functionality is disabled while in Insert mode
3369 to avoid ending Insert mode with any key that has a modifier.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003370
3371 *'eventignore'* *'ei'*
3372'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "")
3373 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003374 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored.
Bram Moolenaarf193fff2006-04-27 00:02:13 +00003375 When set to "all" or when "all" is one of the items, all autocommand
3376 events are ignored, autocommands will not be executed.
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01003377 Otherwise this is a comma-separated list of event names. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003378 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave
3379<
Luuk van Baalb7147f82025-02-08 18:52:39 +01003380 *'eventignorewin'* *'eiw'*
3381'eventignorewin' 'eiw' string (default "")
3382 window-local
3383 Similar to 'eventignore' but applies to a particular window and its
3384 buffers, for which window and buffer related autocommands can be
3385 ignored indefinitely without affecting the global 'eventignore'.
3386
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003387 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'*
3388'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off)
3389 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003390 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003391 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003392 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is
3393 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02003394 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and restored when
3395 the 'paste' option is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003396 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3397
3398 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'*
3399'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off)
3400 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003401 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current
Bram Moolenaar36f44c22016-08-28 18:17:20 +02003402 directory.
3403
3404 Setting this option is a potential security leak. E.g., consider
3405 unpacking a package or fetching files from github, a .vimrc in there
3406 might be a trojan horse. BETTER NOT SET THIS OPTION!
3407 Instead, define an autocommand in your .vimrc to set options for a
3408 matching directory.
3409
3410 If you do switch this option on you should also consider setting the
3411 'secure' option (see |initialization|).
3412 Also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003413 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3414 security reasons.
3415
3416 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213*
3417'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "")
3418 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003419 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003420
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003421 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003422 done when writing the file. For reading see below.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003423 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be
3424 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file).
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01003425 No error will be given when the value is set, only when it is used,
3426 only when writing a file.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003427 Conversion will also be done when 'encoding' and 'fileencoding' are
3428 both a Unicode encoding and 'fileencoding' is not utf-8. That's
3429 because internally Unicode is always stored as utf-8.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003430 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003431 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding, conversion
3432 is most likely done in a way that the reverse conversion
3433 results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some
3434 characters may be lost!
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003435
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003436 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be
3437 specified that can be handled by the converter, see
3438 |mbyte-conversion|.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003439
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003440 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'.
3441 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003442 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument. One exception: when
3443 'fileencodings' is empty the value of 'fileencoding' is used.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003444 For a new file the global value of 'fileencoding' is used.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003445
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003446 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored.
3447 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3448 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are
3449 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for
3450 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example
3451 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2".
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003452
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003453 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3454 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003455
3456 Keep in mind that changing 'fenc' from a modeline happens
3457 AFTER the text has been read, thus it applies to when the file will be
3458 written. If you do set 'fenc' in a modeline, you might want to set
3459 'nomodified' to avoid not being able to ":q".
3460
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003461 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3462
3463 *'fe'*
3464 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003465 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003466 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used.
3467
3468 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'*
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00003469'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom",
3470 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when
3471 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003472 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003473 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit
3474 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first
3475 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one
3476 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003477 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003478 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used.
3479 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
3480 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants)
3481 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse
3482 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not
Bram Moolenaarc6d8db72005-12-13 20:04:55 +00003483 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use
3484 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters
3485 that can't be converted.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003486 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings
3487 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except
3488 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer
3489 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your
3490 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: >
3491 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 |
3492 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif
3493< This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain
3494 non-blank characters.
Bram Moolenaarc6d8db72005-12-13 20:04:55 +00003495 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is
3496 not used.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003497 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, the global value
3498 of 'fileencoding' is used instead. You can set it with: >
3499 :setglobal fenc=iso-8859-2
3500< This means that a non-existing file may get a different encoding than
3501 an empty file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003502 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM
3503 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded
3504 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly.
3505 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last,
3506 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always
3507 accepted.
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00003508 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the
K.Takataef8706f2021-05-31 18:40:49 +02003509 environment. On MS-Windows this is the system encoding. Otherwise
3510 this is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful when
3511 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a non-latin1
3512 encoding, such as Russian.
Bram Moolenaarca003e12006-03-17 23:19:38 +00003513 When 'encoding' is "utf-8" and a file contains an illegal byte
3514 sequence it won't be recognized as UTF-8. You can use the |8g8|
3515 command to find the illegal byte sequence.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003516 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG:
3517 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used
3518 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8
3519 file
3520 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used
3521 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified.
3522 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values.
3523 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file
3524 is read.
3525
3526 *'fileformat'* *'ff'*
Bram Moolenaar00590742019-02-15 21:06:09 +01003527'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-Windows default: "dos",
Yee Cheng Chin92b59c62024-10-22 21:16:43 +02003528 Unix default: "unix")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003529 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003530 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for
3531 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file:
Bram Moolenaar4072ba52020-12-23 13:56:35 +01003532 dos <CR><NL>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003533 unix <NL>
3534 mac <CR>
3535 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored.
3536 See |file-formats| and |file-read|.
3537 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'.
3538 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O
Bram Moolenaarbf884932013-04-05 22:26:15 +02003539 works like it was set to "unix".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003540 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and
3541 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off.
3542 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3543 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
3544 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3545 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos",
3546 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset.
3547
3548 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'*
3549'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default:
Bram Moolenaar00590742019-02-15 21:06:09 +01003550 Vim+Vi MS-Windows: "dos,unix",
Yee Cheng Chin92b59c62024-10-22 21:16:43 +02003551 Vim Unix: "unix,dos",
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003552 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos",
3553 Vi others: "")
3554 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003555 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when
3556 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing
3557 buffer:
3558 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used
3559 always. It is not set automatically.
3560 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003561 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003562 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing
3563 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to.
3564 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic
3565 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to
3566 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>:
3567 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos",
3568 'fileformat' is set to "dos".
3569 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003570 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003571 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos".
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +01003572 3. If 'fileformat' has not yet been set, and if a <CR> is found, and
3573 if 'fileformats' includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
Bram Moolenaar00659062010-09-21 22:34:02 +02003574 This means that "mac" is only chosen when:
3575 "unix" is not present or no <NL> is found in the file, and
3576 "dos" is not present or no <CR><NL> is found in the file.
3577 Except: if "unix" was chosen, but there is a <CR> before
3578 the first <NL>, and there appear to be more <CR>s than <NL>s in
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01003579 the first few lines, "mac" is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003580 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from
3581 'fileformats' is used.
3582 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but
3583 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that
3584 file only, the option is not changed.
3585 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used.
3586
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01003587 When Vim starts up with an empty buffer the first item is used. You
3588 can overrule this by setting 'fileformat' in your .vimrc.
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01003589
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003590 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that
3591 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be
3592 done:
3593 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos
3594 format will be used.
3595 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection
3596 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a
3597 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is
3598 used.
3599 Also see |file-formats|.
3600 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty
3601 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset,
3602 otherwise 'textauto' is set.
3603 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3604 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3605
Bram Moolenaarbf884932013-04-05 22:26:15 +02003606 *'fileignorecase'* *'fic'* *'nofileignorecase'* *'nofic'*
3607'fileignorecase' 'fic' boolean (default on for systems where case in file
3608 names is normally ignored)
Bram Moolenaar71afbfe2013-03-19 16:49:16 +01003609 global
Bram Moolenaar71afbfe2013-03-19 16:49:16 +01003610 When set case is ignored when using file names and directories.
3611 See 'wildignorecase' for only ignoring case when doing completion.
3612
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003613 *'filetype'* *'ft'*
3614'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "")
Christian Brabandt596ad662023-08-16 00:11:09 +02003615 local to buffer |local-noglobal|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003616 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered.
3617 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be
3618 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file
3619 name.
3620 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type.
3621 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable
3622 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype|
3623 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline,
3624 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003625 Example, for in an IDL file:
3626 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */ ~
3627 |FileType| |filetypes|
3628 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
Millyae62fe52024-10-02 19:30:41 +02003629 names, it should therefore not be used for a filetype. Example:
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003630 /* vim: set filetype=c.doxygen : */ ~
3631 This will use the "c" filetype first, then the "doxygen" filetype.
3632 This works both for filetype plugins and for syntax files. More than
3633 one dot may appear.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003634 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
3635 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
Christian Brabandtf0c70902025-05-26 21:18:19 +02003636 Only alphanumeric characters, '-' and '_' can be used (and a '.' is
Doug Kearnsa6172f82025-05-26 20:32:35 +02003637 allowed as delimiter when combining different filetypes).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003638
3639 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'*
Yee Cheng Chin39cd9062024-11-06 20:20:57 +01003640'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-,eob:~,lastline:@")
Bram Moolenaar96ba25a2022-07-04 17:34:33 +01003641 global or local to window |global-local|
glepnirb8762042025-04-07 20:57:14 +02003642 Characters to fill the statuslines, vertical separators, special
3643 lines in the window and truncated text in the |ins-completion-menu|.
Bram Moolenaar96ba25a2022-07-04 17:34:33 +01003644 It is a comma-separated list of items. Each item has a name, a colon
zeertzjq6a8d2e12024-01-17 20:54:49 +01003645 and the value of that item: |E1511|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003646
Bram Moolenaar96ba25a2022-07-04 17:34:33 +01003647 item name default Used for ~
Christian Brabandt6a650bf2023-11-08 21:23:29 +01003648 stl ' ' statusline of the current window
3649 stlnc ' ' statusline of the non-current windows
Bram Moolenaar96ba25a2022-07-04 17:34:33 +01003650 vert '|' vertical separators |:vsplit|
3651 fold '-' filling 'foldtext'
3652 foldopen '-' mark the beginning of a fold
3653 foldclose '+' show a closed fold
3654 foldsep '|' open fold middle character
3655 diff '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option
3656 eob '~' empty lines below the end of a buffer
Bram Moolenaar4ba5f1d2022-10-04 14:36:29 +01003657 lastline '@' 'display' contains lastline/truncate
glepnirb8762042025-04-07 20:57:14 +02003658 trunc '>' truncated text in the
3659 |ins-completion-menu|.
Hirohito Higashifa8b7db2025-04-30 19:12:37 +02003660 truncrl '<' same as "trunc" in 'rightleft' mode
Naruhiko Nishinobe5bd4d2025-05-14 21:20:28 +02003661 tpl_vert '|' vertical separators of 'tabpanel'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003662
Christian Brabandt6a650bf2023-11-08 21:23:29 +01003663 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003664
3665 Example: >
Naruhiko Nishinobe5bd4d2025-05-14 21:20:28 +02003666 :set fillchars=stl:\ ,stlnc:\ ,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:-,tpl_vert:\|
Christian Brabandt6a650bf2023-11-08 21:23:29 +01003667<
Hirohito Higashi0553f2f2025-05-10 14:56:17 +02003668 All items support single-byte and multibyte characters. But
3669 double-width characters are not supported. |E1512|
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003670
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003671 The highlighting used for these items:
Bram Moolenaar96ba25a2022-07-04 17:34:33 +01003672 item name highlight group ~
3673 stl StatusLine |hl-StatusLine|
3674 stlnc StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC|
3675 vert VertSplit |hl-VertSplit|
3676 fold Folded |hl-Folded|
glepnirb8762042025-04-07 20:57:14 +02003677 foldopen FoldColumn |hl-FoldColumn|
3678 foldclose FoldColumn |hl-FoldColumn|
3679 foldsep FoldColumn |hl-FoldColumn|
Bram Moolenaar96ba25a2022-07-04 17:34:33 +01003680 diff DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete|
3681 eob EndOfBuffer |hl-EndOfBuffer|
Bram Moolenaar4ba5f1d2022-10-04 14:36:29 +01003682 lastline NonText |hl-NonText|
glepnirb8762042025-04-07 20:57:14 +02003683 trunc one of the many Popup menu highlighting groups like
3684 |hl-PmenuSel|
glepnird4dbf822025-04-12 18:35:34 +02003685 truncrl same as "trunc"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003686
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +01003687 *'findfunc'* *'ffu'* *E1514*
3688'findfunc' 'ffu' string (default empty)
Yegappan Lakshmananaeb1c972024-10-22 23:42:20 +02003689 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3690 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
3691 feature}
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +01003692 Function that is called to obtain the filename(s) for the |:find|
Yegappan Lakshmananaeb1c972024-10-22 23:42:20 +02003693 command. When this option is empty, the internal |file-searching|
3694 mechanism is used.
3695
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +01003696 The value can be the name of a function, a |lambda| or a |Funcref|.
3697 See |option-value-function| for more information.
Yegappan Lakshmananaeb1c972024-10-22 23:42:20 +02003698
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +01003699 The function is called with two arguments. The first argument is a
3700 |String| and is the |:find| command argument. The second argument is
3701 a |Boolean| and is set to |v:true| when the function is called to get
3702 a List of command-line completion matches for the |:find| command.
3703 The function should return a List of strings.
Yegappan Lakshmananaeb1c972024-10-22 23:42:20 +02003704
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +01003705 The function is called only once per |:find| command invocation.
3706 The function can process all the directories specified in 'path'.
zeertzjq20e045f2024-10-28 22:05:26 +01003707
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +01003708 If a match is found, the function should return a |List| containing
3709 one or more file names. If a match is not found, the function
Yegappan Lakshmananaeb1c972024-10-22 23:42:20 +02003710 should return an empty List.
3711
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +01003712 If any errors are encountered during the function invocation, an
Yegappan Lakshmananaeb1c972024-10-22 23:42:20 +02003713 empty List is used as the return value.
3714
Yegappan Lakshmananaeb1c972024-10-22 23:42:20 +02003715 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +01003716 executing the 'findfunc' |textlock|.
Yegappan Lakshmananaeb1c972024-10-22 23:42:20 +02003717
3718 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3719 security reasons.
3720
3721 Examples:
3722>
3723 " Use glob()
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +01003724 func FindFuncGlob(cmdarg, cmdcomplete)
3725 let pat = a:cmdcomplete ? $'{a:cmdarg}*' : a:cmdarg
zeertzjq20e045f2024-10-28 22:05:26 +01003726 return glob(pat, v:false, v:true)
Yegappan Lakshmananaeb1c972024-10-22 23:42:20 +02003727 endfunc
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +01003728 set findfunc=FindFuncGlob
Yegappan Lakshmananaeb1c972024-10-22 23:42:20 +02003729
3730 " Use the 'git ls-files' output
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +01003731 func FindGitFiles(cmdarg, cmdcomplete)
Yegappan Lakshmananaeb1c972024-10-22 23:42:20 +02003732 let fnames = systemlist('git ls-files')
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +01003733 return fnames->filter('v:val =~? a:cmdarg')
Yegappan Lakshmananaeb1c972024-10-22 23:42:20 +02003734 endfunc
Yegappan Lakshmanana13f3a42024-11-02 18:40:10 +01003735 set findfunc=FindGitFiles
Yegappan Lakshmananaeb1c972024-10-22 23:42:20 +02003736<
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02003737 *'fixendofline'* *'fixeol'* *'nofixendofline'* *'nofixeol'*
3738'fixendofline' 'fixeol' boolean (default on)
3739 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02003740 When writing a file and this option is on, <EOL> at the end of file
Bram Moolenaarfb0cf232022-10-22 11:25:19 +01003741 will be restored if missing. Turn this option off if you want to
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02003742 preserve the situation from the original file.
3743 When the 'binary' option is set the value of this option doesn't
3744 matter.
3745 See the 'endofline' option.
K.Takata3af98212022-11-01 20:36:19 +00003746 See |eol-and-eof| for example settings.
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02003747
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003748 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'*
Bram Moolenaar98a29d02021-01-18 19:55:44 +01003749'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003750 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003751 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3752 feature}
Bram Moolenaar14184a32019-02-16 15:10:30 +01003753 This option was for using Farsi, which has been removed. See
3754 |farsi.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003755
3756 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'*
3757'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "")
3758 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003759 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3760 feature}
3761 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and
3762 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to
3763 automatically close when moving out of them.
3764
3765 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'*
3766'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0)
3767 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003768 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3769 feature}
3770 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side
3771 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum
3772 value is 12.
3773 See |folding|.
3774
3775 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'*
3776'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on)
3777 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003778 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3779 feature}
3780 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly
3781 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with
3782 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003783 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003784 'foldenable' is off.
3785 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold.
3786 See |folding|.
3787
3788 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'*
3789'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0")
3790 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003791 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02003792 or |+eval| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003793 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00003794 for each line to obtain its fold level. The context is set to the
3795 script where 'foldexpr' was set, script-local items can be accessed.
3796 See |fold-expr| for the usage.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003797
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003798 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
3799 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003800 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003801 on or the 'modelineexpr' option is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003802
3803 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
3804 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003805
3806 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'*
3807'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#")
3808 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003809 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3810 feature}
3811 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with
3812 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003813 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003814 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|.
3815
3816 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'*
3817'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0)
3818 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003819 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3820 feature}
3821 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed.
3822 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will
3823 close fewer folds.
3824 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|.
3825 See |fold-foldlevel|.
3826
3827 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'*
3828'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1)
3829 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003830 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3831 feature}
3832 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window.
3833 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero),
3834 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99).
3835 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003836 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003837 ignores this option and closes all folds.
3838 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to
3839 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files.
3840 When the value is negative, it is not used.
3841
3842 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536*
3843'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}")
3844 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003845 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3846 feature}
3847 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There
3848 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The
3849 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow).
3850 See |fold-marker|.
3851
3852 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'*
3853'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual")
3854 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003855 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3856 feature}
3857 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values:
3858 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually.
3859 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold.
3860 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line.
3861 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds.
3862 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds.
3863 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed.
3864
3865 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'*
3866'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1)
3867 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003868 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3869 feature}
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01003870 Sets the number of screen lines above which a fold can be displayed
3871 closed. Also for manually closed folds. With the default value of
3872 one a fold can only be closed if it takes up two or more screen lines.
3873 Set to zero to be able to close folds of just one screen line.
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +02003874 Note that this only has an effect on what is displayed. After using
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003875 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller
3876 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold.
3877
3878 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'*
3879'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20)
3880 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003881 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3882 feature}
3883 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax"
3884 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more
3885 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20.
3886
3887 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'*
3888'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix,
3889 search,tag,undo")
3890 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003891 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3892 feature}
3893 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01003894 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma-separated
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003895 list of items.
Bram Moolenaar05365702010-10-27 18:34:44 +02003896 NOTE: When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used.
3897 Add the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect.
3898 (rationale: the mapping may want to control opening folds itself)
3899
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003900 item commands ~
3901 all any
3902 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc.
3903 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc.
3904 insert any command in Insert mode
3905 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc.
3906 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc.
3907 percent "%"
3908 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc.
3909 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc.
3910 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command)
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003911 Also for |[s| and |]s|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003912 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc.
3913 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003914 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%")
3915 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the
3916 whole closed fold.
3917 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it
3918 very difficult to move onto a closed fold.
3919 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open
3920 when text is inserted.
3921 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or
3922 set the 'foldclose' option to "all".
3923
3924 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'*
3925'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()")
3926 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003927 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3928 feature}
3929 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00003930 fold. The context is set to the script where 'foldexpr' was set,
3931 script-local items can be accessed. See |fold-foldtext| for the
3932 usage.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003933
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003934 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
3935 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003936 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003937
3938 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
3939 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|.
3940
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003941 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'*
3942'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "")
3943 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003944 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
3945 feature}
3946 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq|
3947 operator or automatic formatting (see 'formatoptions'). When this
3948 option is empty 'formatprg' is used.
3949
3950 The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted.
3951 The |v:count| variable holds the number of lines to be formatted.
3952 The |v:char| variable holds the character that is going to be
3953 inserted if the expression is being evaluated due to
3954 automatic formatting. This can be empty. Don't insert
3955 it yet!
3956
3957 Example: >
3958 :set formatexpr=mylang#Format()
3959< This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the
3960 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload|
3961
Bram Moolenaara4e0b972022-10-01 19:43:52 +01003962 The advantage of using a function call without arguments is that it is
3963 faster, see |expr-option-function|.
3964
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003965 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding
3966 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as
3967 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the
3968 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will
3969 return "i" or "R" in this situation.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01003970
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003971 When the expression evaluates to non-zero Vim will fall back to using
3972 the internal format mechanism.
3973
Yegappan Lakshmanan8bb65f22021-12-26 10:51:39 +00003974 If the expression starts with s: or |<SID>|, then it is replaced with
3975 the script ID (|local-function|). Example: >
3976 set formatexpr=s:MyFormatExpr()
3977 set formatexpr=<SID>SomeFormatExpr()
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00003978< Otherwise, the expression is evaluated in the context of the script
3979 where the option was set, thus script-local items are available.
3980
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003981 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
3982 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. That stops the option from working,
3983 since changing the buffer text is not allowed.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003984 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01003985 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003986
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003987 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'*
3988'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*")
3989 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003990 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for
3991 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'.
3992 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00003993 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003994 while still checking more characters. There must be a character
3995 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled
3996 like there is no match.
3997 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation
3998 character and white space.
3999
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02004000 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'*
4001'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt")
4002 local to buffer
4003 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic
Christian Brabandt1b08d2c2023-11-11 15:50:13 +01004004 formatting is to be done.
4005 See |fo-table| for possible values and |gq| for how to format text.
4006 When the 'paste' option is on, no formatting is done (like
4007 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can be inserted for readability.
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02004008 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
4009 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
4010 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
4011 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
4012
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004013 *'formatprg'* *'fp'*
4014'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar9be7c042017-01-14 14:28:30 +01004015 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004016 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00004017 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004018 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00004019 such a program.
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00004020 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead.
4021 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal
4022 format function will be used |C-indenting|.
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00004023 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
4024 about including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02004025 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4026 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004027
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01004028 *'fsync'* *'fs'* *'nofsync'* *'nofs'*
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00004029'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on)
4030 global
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00004031 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a
4032 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely
4033 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This
4034 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop
4035 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that
4036 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On
4037 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always
4038 off.
4039 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files.
Bram Moolenaar340dd0f2021-10-14 17:52:23 +01004040 'fsync' also applies to |writefile()| (unless a flag is used to
4041 overrule it) and when writing undo files (see |undo-persistence|).
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004042 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4043 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00004044
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004045 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'*
4046'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off)
4047 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004048 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that
4049 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag
4050 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution
4051 of all or one match. See |complex-change|.
4052
4053 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~
4054 :s/// subst. all subst. one
4055 :s///g subst. one subst. all
4056 :s///gg subst. all subst. one
4057
4058 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
dundargoc82f19732023-12-16 14:53:52 +01004059 Setting this option may break plugins that rely on the default
4060 behavior of the 'g' flag. This will also make the 'g' flag have the
4061 opposite effect of that documented in |:s_g|.
Bram Moolenaar4072ba52020-12-23 13:56:35 +01004062 This option is not used in |Vim9| script.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004063
4064 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'*
Bram Moolenaar6e932462014-09-09 18:48:09 +02004065'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l:%m,%f:%l%m,%f %l%m")
glepnir7b9eb632025-05-16 19:49:23 +02004066 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004067 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output.
4068 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the
4069 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|.
4070
4071 *'grepprg'* *'gp'*
4072'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ",
4073 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null",
4074 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n",
4075 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ")
4076 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004077 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004078 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command-
4079 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments
4080 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See
4081 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
4082 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep"
4083 also work well with a single file: >
4084 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00004085< Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command
Bram Moolenaara6557602006-02-04 22:43:20 +00004086 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like
4087 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|.
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00004088 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004089 apply equally to 'grepprg'.
4090 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found,
4091 otherwise it's "grep -n".
4092 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4093 security reasons.
4094
4095 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549*
4096'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor,
4097 ve:ver35-Cursor,
4098 o:hor50-Cursor,
4099 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor,
4100 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor,
4101 sm:block-Cursor
4102 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175",
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01004103 for Win32 console:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004104 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15,
4105 r-cr:hor30,sm:block")
4106 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004107 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01004108 for Win32 console}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004109 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01004110 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In a Win32 console, only the
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01004111 height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by specifying a
4112 block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or horizontal cursor.
Bram Moolenaar1e7813a2015-03-31 18:31:03 +02004113 For a console the 't_SI', 't_SR', and 't_EI' escape sequences are
4114 used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004115
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004116 The option is a comma-separated list of parts. Each part consist of a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004117 mode-list and an argument-list:
4118 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,..
4119 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes:
4120 n Normal mode
4121 v Visual mode
4122 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
4123 if not specified)
4124 o Operator-pending mode
4125 i Insert mode
4126 r Replace mode
4127 c Command-line Normal (append) mode
4128 ci Command-line Insert mode
4129 cr Command-line Replace mode
4130 sm showmatch in Insert mode
4131 a all modes
4132 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments:
4133 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height
4134 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width
4135 block block cursor, fills the whole character
4136 [only one of the above three should be present]
4137 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking*
4138 blinkon{N}
4139 blinkoff{N}
4140 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before
4141 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that
4142 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the
4143 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one
4144 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The
4145 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250".
4146 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This
4147 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch
4148 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only
4149 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while
4150 executing a command.
4151 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see
4152 |xterm-blink|.
4153 {group-name}
4154 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font
4155 for the cursor
4156 {group-name}/{group-name}
4157 Two highlight group names, the first is used when
4158 no language mappings are used, the other when they
4159 are. |language-mapping|
4160
4161 Examples of parts:
4162 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a
4163 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor"
4164 highlight group
4165 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150
4166 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a
4167 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the
4168 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit
4169 faster.
4170
4171 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for
4172 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used
4173 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off
4174 blinking: "a:blinkon0"
4175
4176 Examples of cursor highlighting: >
4177 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE
4178 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg
4179<
4180 *'guifont'* *'gfn'*
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02004181 *E235* *E596*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004182'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "")
4183 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004184 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
4185 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim.
Bram Moolenaarf720d0a2019-04-28 14:02:47 +02004186 In its simplest form the value is just one font name.
4187 See |gui-font| for the details.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004188
4189 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'*
4190 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598*
4191'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "")
4192 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004193 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
4194 with the |+xfontset| feature}
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01004195 {not available in the GTK+ GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004196 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first
4197 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See
4198 |xfontset|.
Bram Moolenaarf720d0a2019-04-28 14:02:47 +02004199
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004200 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534*
4201'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "")
4202 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004203 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
4204 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used
4205 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is
Bram Moolenaarf720d0a2019-04-28 14:02:47 +02004206 used. See |gui-fontwide|.
Bram Moolenaar0f272122013-01-23 18:37:40 +01004207
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004208 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'*
4209'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50)
4210 global
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004211 {only for GTK and X11 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004212 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting
4213 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started,
4214 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004215 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004216 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the
4217 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the
4218 screen.
4219
Dusan Popovic4eeedc02021-10-16 20:52:05 +01004220 *'guiligatures'* *'gli'* *E1243*
4221'guiligatures' 'gli' string (default "")
4222 global
Erik S. V. Jansson8b1e7492024-02-24 14:26:52 +01004223 {only for GTK and Win32 GUI}
Dusan Popovic4eeedc02021-10-16 20:52:05 +01004224 List of ASCII characters that, when combined together, can create more
4225 complex shapes. Each character must be a printable ASCII character
4226 with a value in the 32-127 range.
4227 Example: >
4228 :set guiligatures=!\"#$%&()*+-./:<=>?@[]^_{\|~
4229< Changing this option updates screen output immediately. Set it to an
4230 empty string to disable ligatures.
4231
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004232 *'guioptions'* *'go'*
Bram Moolenaar2c64ca12018-10-19 16:22:31 +02004233'guioptions' 'go' string (default "egmrLtT" (MS-Windows,
4234 "t" is removed in |defaults.vim|),
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004235 "aegimrLtT" (GTK and Motif),
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004236 )
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004237 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004238 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00004239 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004240 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the
4241 GUI should be used.
4242 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
4243 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
4244
Bram Moolenaar13568252018-03-16 20:46:58 +01004245 Valid characters are as follows:
4246 *'go-!'*
4247 '!' External commands are executed in a terminal window. Without
4248 this flag the MS-Windows GUI will open a console window to
4249 execute the command. The Unix GUI will simulate a dumb
4250 terminal to list the command output.
4251 The terminal window will be positioned at the bottom, and grow
4252 upwards as needed.
Bram Moolenaarba3ff532018-11-04 14:45:49 +01004253 *'go-a'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004254 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started,
4255 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of
4256 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the
4257 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other
4258 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode
4259 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an
4260 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text
4261 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register.
4262 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other
4263 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended.
4264 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the
4265 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to
4266 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register.
4267 The same applies to the modeless selection.
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02004268 *'go-P'*
4269 'P' Like autoselect but using the "+ register instead of the "*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01004270 register.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004271 *'go-A'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004272 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004273 applies to the modeless selection.
4274
4275 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~
4276 "" - -
4277 "a" yes yes
4278 "A" - yes
4279 "aA" yes yes
4280
Bram Moolenaar9fbdbb82022-09-27 17:30:34 +01004281 When using a terminal see the 'clipboard' option.
4282
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004283 *'go-c'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004284 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple
4285 choices.
Bram Moolenaar50bf7ce2019-09-15 13:17:00 +02004286 *'go-d'*
4287 'd' Use dark theme variant if available. Currently only works for
4288 GTK+ GUI.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004289 *'go-e'*
Bram Moolenaare224ffa2006-03-01 00:01:28 +00004290 'e' Add tab pages when indicated with 'showtabline'.
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00004291 'guitablabel' can be used to change the text in the labels.
4292 When 'e' is missing a non-GUI tab pages line may be used.
Bram Moolenaard68071d2006-05-02 22:08:30 +00004293 The GUI tabs are only supported on some systems, currently
Bram Moolenaarb3f74062020-02-26 16:16:53 +01004294 GTK, Motif, Mac OS/X, Haiku, and MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004295 *'go-f'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004296 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell
4297 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the
4298 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you
4299 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the
4300 foreground. |gui-fork|
4301 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00004302 happened already when the |gvimrc| file is read.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004303 *'go-i'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004304 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper
4305 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of
4306 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004307 *'go-m'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004308 'm' Menu bar is present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004309 *'go-M'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004310 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004311 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00004312 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the |gvimrc|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004313 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +01004314 `:syntax on` and `:filetype on` commands load the menu too).
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004315 *'go-g'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004316 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If
4317 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004318 *'go-t'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004319 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32,
4320 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004321 *'go-T'*
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004322 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif and
4323 Photon GUIs.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004324 *'go-r'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004325 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004326 *'go-R'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004327 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
4328 split window.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004329 *'go-l'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004330 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004331 *'go-L'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004332 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
4333 split window.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004334 *'go-b'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004335 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on
4336 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h'
4337 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll|
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004338 *'go-h'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004339 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor
4340 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll|
4341
4342 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if
4343 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information.
4344
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004345 *'go-v'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004346 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included,
4347 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a
Bram Moolenaardad44732021-03-31 20:07:33 +02004348 vertical layout is used anyway. Not supported in GTK 3.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004349 *'go-p'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004350 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some
4351 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at
4352 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00004353 before starting the GUI. Set it in your |gvimrc|. Adding or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004354 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004355 *'go-F'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004356 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|.
Bram Moolenaar8ac44152017-11-09 18:33:29 +01004357 *'go-k'*
4358 'k' Keep the GUI window size when adding/removing a scrollbar, or
4359 toolbar, tabline, etc. Instead, the behavior is similar to
4360 when the window is maximized and will adjust 'lines' and
4361 'columns' to fit to the window. Without the 'k' flag Vim will
Bram Moolenaar51b0f372017-11-18 18:52:04 +01004362 try to keep 'lines' and 'columns' the same when adding and
Bram Moolenaar8ac44152017-11-09 18:33:29 +01004363 removing GUI components.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004364
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004365 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'*
4366'guipty' boolean (default on)
4367 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004368 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
4369 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for
4370 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|.
4371
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00004372 *'guitablabel'* *'gtl'*
4373'guitablabel' 'gtl' string (default empty)
4374 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02004375 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
Bram Moolenaar944697a2022-02-20 19:48:20 +00004376 When non-empty describes the text to use in a label of the GUI tab
Bram Moolenaard68071d2006-05-02 22:08:30 +00004377 pages line. When empty and when the result is empty Vim will use a
4378 default label. See |setting-guitablabel| for more info.
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00004379
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00004380 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00004381 'guitabtooltip' is used for the tooltip, see below.
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +01004382 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4383 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004384 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00004385
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00004386 Only used when the GUI tab pages line is displayed. 'e' must be
4387 present in 'guioptions'. For the non-GUI tab pages line 'tabline' is
4388 used.
4389
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00004390 *'guitabtooltip'* *'gtt'*
4391'guitabtooltip' 'gtt' string (default empty)
4392 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02004393 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
Bram Moolenaar944697a2022-02-20 19:48:20 +00004394 When non-empty describes the text to use in a tooltip for the GUI tab
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00004395 pages line. When empty Vim will use a default tooltip.
4396 This option is otherwise just like 'guitablabel' above.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004397 You can include a line break. Simplest method is to use |:let|: >
4398 :let &guitabtooltip = "line one\nline two"
4399<
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00004400
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004401 *'helpfile'* *'hf'*
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01004402'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MS-Windows) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004403 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt")
4404 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004405 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be
4406 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories
4407 in 'runtimepath' will be used.
4408 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example:
4409 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004410 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004411 spaces and backslashes.
4412 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4413 security reasons.
4414
4415 *'helpheight'* *'hh'*
4416'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20)
4417 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004418 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the
4419 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the
4420 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other
4421 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is
4422 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable.
4423
4424 *'helplang'* *'hlg'*
4425'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty)
4426 global
4427 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang|
4428 feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004429 Comma-separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004430 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always
4431 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over
4432 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that
4433 language and not in the English help.
4434 Example: >
4435 :set helplang=de,it
4436< This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help
4437 files.
4438 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will
4439 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option.
4440 See |help-translated|.
4441
4442 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'*
4443'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off)
4444 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004445 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a
4446 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still
4447 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course.
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004448
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004449 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004450 hidden even if the 'hidden' option is off when these three are true:
4451 - the buffer is modified
4452 - 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible
4453 - the '!' flag was used
4454 Also see |windows.txt|.
4455
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00004456 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004457 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|.
4458 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers.
4459 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!".
4460
4461 *'highlight'* *'hl'*
4462'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string):
Bram Moolenaar58b85342016-08-14 19:54:54 +02004463 "8:SpecialKey,~:EndOfBuffer,@:NonText,
4464 d:Directory,e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch,
4465 l:Search,m:MoreMsg,M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr,
Bram Moolenaarefae76a2019-10-27 22:54:58 +01004466 a:LineNrAbove,b:LineNrBelow,
Bram Moolenaar58b85342016-08-14 19:54:54 +02004467 N:CursorLineNr,r:Question,s:StatusLine,
4468 S:StatusLineNC,c:VertSplit,t:Title,
Bram Moolenaar9d87a372018-12-18 21:41:50 +01004469 v:Visual,V:VisualNOS,w:WarningMsg,
4470 W:WildMenu,f:Folded,F:FoldColumn,
4471 A:DiffAdd,C:DiffChange,D:DiffDelete,
Yee Cheng Chin9943d472025-03-26 19:41:02 +01004472 T:DiffText,E:DiffTextAdd,>:SignColumn,
4473 -:Conceal,B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,
4474 R:SpellRare, L:SpellLocal,+:Pmenu,
4475 =:PmenuSel, k:PmenuMatch,<:PmenuMatchSel,
Gianmaria Bajo6a7c7742023-03-10 16:35:53 +00004476 [:PmenuKind,]:PmenuKindSel,
4477 {:PmenuExtra,}:PmenuExtraSel,
Bram Moolenaar21020352017-06-13 17:21:04 +02004478 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb,*:TabLine,
4479 #:TabLineSel,_:TabLineFill,!:CursorColumn,
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02004480 .:CursorLine,o:ColorColumn,q:QuickFixLine,
Christian Brabandtfb745752024-05-07 21:19:03 +02004481 z:StatusLineTerm,Z:StatusLineTermNC,
glepnirad409872025-01-10 20:08:20 +01004482 g:MsgArea,h:ComplMatchIns")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004483 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004484 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004485 occasions. It is a comma-separated list of character pairs. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004486 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004487 use for that occasion. The occasions are:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004488 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map"
Bram Moolenaar58b85342016-08-14 19:54:54 +02004489 |hl-EndOfBuffer| ~ lines after the last line in the buffer
4490 |hl-NonText| @ '@' at the end of the window and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004491 characters from 'showbreak'
4492 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special
4493 things in listings
4494 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages
4495 h (obsolete, ignored)
4496 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting
LemonBoya4399382022-04-09 21:04:08 +01004497 |hl-CurSearch| y current instance of last search pattern
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004498 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch')
4499 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt|
4500 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --")
Christian Brabandtfb745752024-05-07 21:19:03 +02004501 |hl-MsgArea| g |Command-line| and message area
glepnirad409872025-01-10 20:08:20 +01004502 |hl-ComplMatchIns| h matched text of currently inserted completion
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02004503 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands, and
4504 when 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set.
Bram Moolenaarefae76a2019-10-27 22:54:58 +01004505 |hl-LineNrAbove| a line number above the cursor for when the
4506 'relativenumber' option is set.
4507 |hl-LineNrBelow| b line number below the cursor for when the
4508 'relativenumber' option is set.
Bram Moolenaara3e6bc92013-01-30 14:18:00 +01004509 |hl-CursorLineNr| N like n for when 'cursorline' or 'relativenumber' is
4510 set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004511 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions
4512 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line|
Bram Moolenaarb0d45e72017-11-05 18:19:24 +01004513 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004514 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc.
4515 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows
4516 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode
4517 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the
4518 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and
4519 |xterm-clipboard|.
4520 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages
4521 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu'
4522 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds
4523 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn'
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00004524 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode
4525 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode
4526 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode
Yee Cheng Chin9943d472025-03-26 19:41:02 +01004527 |hl-DiffText| T changed text in diff mode
4528 |hl-DiffTextAdd| E inserted text in diff mode
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004529 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs|
Bram Moolenaar9d87a372018-12-18 21:41:50 +01004530 |hl-Conceal| - the placeholders used for concealed characters
4531 (see 'conceallevel')
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00004532 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell|
Bram Moolenaar9855d6b2010-07-18 14:34:51 +02004533 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital |spell|
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00004534 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell|
4535 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell|
Bram Moolenaar9d87a372018-12-18 21:41:50 +01004536 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line
4537 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu selected line
Gianmaria Bajo6a7c7742023-03-10 16:35:53 +00004538 |hl-PmenuKind| [ popup menu "kind" normal line
4539 |hl-PmenuKindSel| ] popup menu "kind" selected line
h_east59858792023-10-25 22:47:05 +09004540 |hl-PmenuExtra| { popup menu "extra" normal line
4541 |hl-PmenuExtraSel| } popup menu "extra" selected line
Bram Moolenaar9d87a372018-12-18 21:41:50 +01004542 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar
4543 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb
glepnir40c1c332024-06-11 19:37:04 +02004544 |hl-PmenuMatch| k popup menu matched text
4545 |hl-PmenuMatchSel| < popup menu matched text in selected line
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004546
4547 The display modes are:
4548 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me")
4549 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR")
4550 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me")
4551 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se")
4552 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue")
Bram Moolenaar84f54632022-06-29 18:39:11 +01004553 c undercurl (termcap entry "Us" and "Ce")
4554 2 double underline (termcap entry "Ds" and "Ce")
4555 d dotted underline (termcap entry "ds" and "Ce")
4556 = dashed underline (termcap entry "Ds" and "Ce")
Bram Moolenaarcf4b00c2017-09-02 18:33:56 +02004557 t strikethrough (termcap entry "Ts" and "Te")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004558 n no highlighting
4559 - no highlighting
4560 : use a highlight group
4561 The default is used for occasions that are not included.
4562 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors|
4563 for an example.
4564 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of
4565 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type
4566 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to
4567 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion.
4568 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups.
4569
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004570 *'history'* *'hi'*
Luca Saccarolac0d30ef2024-11-28 22:27:28 +01004571'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 200, Vi default: 0)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004572 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004573 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns
Bram Moolenaar78159bb2014-06-25 11:48:54 +02004574 is remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in
Christian Brabandt51d4d842024-12-06 17:26:25 +01004575 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing| and 'messagesopt' for
Shougo Matsushita4bd9b2b2024-11-14 22:31:48 +01004576 the number of messages to remember).
Bram Moolenaar78159bb2014-06-25 11:48:54 +02004577 The maximum value is 10000.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004578 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
4579 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
4580
4581 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'*
4582'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off)
4583 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004584 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
4585 feature}
4586 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set.
4587 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
4588 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|.
4589 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4590
4591 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'*
4592'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off)
4593 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004594 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
4595 feature}
4596 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on.
4597 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard.
4598 See |rileft.txt|.
4599 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4600
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01004601 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'*
4602'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off)
4603 global
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01004604 {not available when compiled without the
4605 |+extra_search| feature}
4606 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches.
4607 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the
4608 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by
4609 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets
Bram Moolenaarcfa8f9a2022-06-03 21:59:47 +01004610 are not applied. If the "CurSearch" highlight group is set then the
4611 current match is highlighted with that.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01004612 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|.
4613 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it
4614 off with |:nohlsearch|. This does not change the option value, as
4615 soon as you use a search command, the highlighting comes back.
4616 'redrawtime' specifies the maximum time spent on finding matches.
4617 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to
4618 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the
4619 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first
4620 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not
4621 drawn may not continue in a newly drawn line.
4622 You can specify whether the highlight status is restored on startup
4623 with the 'h' flag in 'viminfo' |viminfo-h|.
4624 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4625
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004626 *'icon'* *'noicon'*
4627'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
4628 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004629 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of
4630 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file
4631 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used.
4632 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option.
4633 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently
4634 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are
4635 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the
4636 builtin termcap).
4637 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004638 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004639 X11.
Bram Moolenaar3a991dd2014-10-02 01:41:41 +02004640 For MS-Windows the icon can be changed, see |windows-icon|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004641
4642 *'iconstring'*
4643'iconstring' string (default "")
4644 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004645 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of
4646 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on.
4647 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text
4648 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option).
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02004649 Does not work for MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004650 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
4651 restored if possible |X11|.
4652 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004653 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004654 'titlestring' for example settings.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004655 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004656 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
4657
4658 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'*
4659'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off)
4660 global
Yee Cheng Chin2bbd0d32023-10-14 02:23:45 -07004661 Ignore case in search patterns, |cmdline-completion|, when
glepnir05460682025-05-26 18:23:27 +02004662 searching in the tags file, non-|Vim9| |expr-==| and for Insert-mode
4663 completion |ins-completion|.
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01004664 Also see 'smartcase' and 'tagcase'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004665 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see
4666 |/ignorecase|.
4667
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004668 *'imactivatefunc'* *'imaf'*
4669'imactivatefunc' 'imaf' string (default "")
4670 global
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004671 This option specifies a function that will be called to
Yegappan Lakshmanan7645da52021-12-04 14:02:30 +00004672 activate or deactivate the Input Method. The value can be the name of
4673 a function, a |lambda| or a |Funcref|. See |option-value-function| for
4674 more information.
Bram Moolenaaref8c6172020-07-01 15:12:44 +02004675 It is not used in the MS-Windows GUI version.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004676 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4677 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004678
4679 Example: >
4680 function ImActivateFunc(active)
4681 if a:active
4682 ... do something
4683 else
4684 ... do something
4685 endif
4686 " return value is not used
4687 endfunction
4688 set imactivatefunc=ImActivateFunc
4689<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004690 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'*
4691'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "")
4692 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004693 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
Bram Moolenaar67c53842010-05-22 18:28:27 +02004694 |+GUI_GTK|} *E599*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004695 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for
4696 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control
4697 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'.
4698 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option
4699 tells Vim what the key is.
4700 Format:
4701 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING
4702
4703 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored):
4704 S Shift key
4705 L Lock key
4706 C Control key
4707 1 Mod1 key
4708 2 Mod2 key
4709 3 Mod3 key
4710 4 Mod4 key
4711 5 Mod5 key
4712 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are
4713 both shift+ctrl+space.
4714 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING.
4715
4716 Example: >
4717 :set imactivatekey=S-space
4718< "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 +
4719 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean).
4720
4721 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'*
4722'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off)
4723 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004724 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command
4725 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that).
4726 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering
4727 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented
4728 characters with dead keys.
4729
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004730 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'noimdisable'* *'noimd'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004731'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI))
4732 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004733 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable
4734 the IM when it doesn't work properly.
4735 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This
4736 may change in later releases.
4737
4738 *'iminsert'* *'imi'*
Bram Moolenaar4cf56bb2017-09-16 15:50:32 +02004739'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004740 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004741 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in
4742 Insert mode. Valid values:
4743 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
4744 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
4745 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004746 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc>
4747 this can be used: >
4748 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR>
4749< This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert
4750 mode.
4751 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode
4752 |i_CTRL-^|.
4753 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name.
4754 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f".
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004755 The value 0 may not work correctly with Motif with some XIM
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004756 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
4757
Bram Moolenaar6315a9a2017-11-25 15:20:02 +01004758 You can set 'imactivatefunc' and 'imstatusfunc' to handle IME/XIM
Bram Moolenaard473c8c2018-08-11 18:00:22 +02004759 via external command if Vim is not compiled with the |+xim|,
Bram Moolenaar6315a9a2017-11-25 15:20:02 +01004760 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime|.
4761
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004762 *'imsearch'* *'ims'*
Bram Moolenaar4cf56bb2017-09-16 15:50:32 +02004763'imsearch' 'ims' number (default -1)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004764 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004765 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when
4766 entering a search pattern. Valid values:
4767 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like
4768 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern
4769 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
4770 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
4771 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
4772 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode
4773 |c_CTRL-^|.
4774 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap'
4775 option to a valid keymap name.
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004776 The value 0 may not work correctly with Motif with some XIM
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004777 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
4778
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004779 *'imstatusfunc'* *'imsf'*
4780'imstatusfunc' 'imsf' string (default "")
4781 global
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004782 This option specifies a function that is called to obtain the status
4783 of Input Method. It must return a positive number when IME is active.
Yegappan Lakshmanan7645da52021-12-04 14:02:30 +00004784 The value can be the name of a function, a |lambda| or a |Funcref|.
4785 See |option-value-function| for more information.
Bram Moolenaaref8c6172020-07-01 15:12:44 +02004786 It is not used in the MS-Windows GUI version.
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004787
4788 Example: >
4789 function ImStatusFunc()
4790 let is_active = ...do something
4791 return is_active ? 1 : 0
4792 endfunction
4793 set imstatusfunc=ImStatusFunc
4794<
4795 NOTE: This function is invoked very often. Keep it fast.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004796 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4797 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004798
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004799 *'imstyle'* *'imst'*
4800'imstyle' 'imst' number (default 1)
4801 global
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004802 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
4803 |+GUI_GTK|}
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +02004804 This option specifies the input style of Input Method:
4805 0 use on-the-spot style
4806 1 over-the-spot style
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004807 See: |xim-input-style|
4808
Bram Moolenaar24a98a02017-09-27 22:23:55 +02004809 For a long time on-the-spot style had been used in the GTK version of
4810 vim, however, it is known that it causes troubles when using mappings,
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004811 |single-repeat|, etc. Therefore over-the-spot style becomes the
4812 default now. This should work fine for most people, however if you
4813 have any problem with it, try using on-the-spot style.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004814 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4815 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004816
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004817 *'include'* *'inc'*
4818'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include")
4819 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004820 {not available when compiled without the
4821 |+find_in_path| feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004822 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004823 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default
4824 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i",
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00004825 "]I", "[d", etc.
4826 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00004827 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern
4828 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it
4829 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters
4830 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use
4831 'includeexpr' to process the matched text.
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00004832 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004833
4834 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'*
4835'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "")
4836 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004837 {not available when compiled without the
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004838 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004839 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004840 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: >
Bram Moolenaarb59ae592022-11-23 23:46:31 +00004841 :setlocal includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g')
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004842< The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected.
Bram Moolenaarb59ae592022-11-23 23:46:31 +00004843 Note the double backslash: the `:set` command first halves them, then
4844 one remains it the value, where "\." matches a dot literally. For
4845 simple character replacements `tr()` avoids the need for escaping: >
4846 :setlocal includeexpr=tr(v:fname,'.','/')
4847<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004848 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004849 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement.
Christian Brabandt23984602025-04-19 11:54:08 +02004850 Note: Not used for |<cfile>|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004851
Yegappan Lakshmanan8bb65f22021-12-26 10:51:39 +00004852 If the expression starts with s: or |<SID>|, then it is replaced with
4853 the script ID (|local-function|). Example: >
Bram Moolenaarb59ae592022-11-23 23:46:31 +00004854 setlocal includeexpr=s:MyIncludeExpr()
4855 setlocal includeexpr=<SID>SomeIncludeExpr()
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00004856< Otherwise, the expression is evaluated in the context of the script
4857 where the option was set, thus script-local items are available.
4858
Bram Moolenaara4e0b972022-10-01 19:43:52 +01004859 It is more efficient if the value is just a function call without
4860 arguments, see |expr-option-function|.
4861
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02004862 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4863 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004864 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004865
4866 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
4867 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|.
4868
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004869 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004870'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim| if the
Bram Moolenaar8a3b8052022-06-26 12:21:15 +01004871 |+reltime| feature is supported)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004872 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004873 {not available when compiled without the
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004874 |+extra_search| features}
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00004875 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed
4876 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern
4877 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated
4878 often, this is only useful on fast terminals.
Bram Moolenaarfc65cab2018-08-28 22:58:02 +02004879 Also applies to the pattern in commands: >
4880 :global
4881 :lvimgrep
4882 :lvimgrepadd
4883 :smagic
4884 :snomagic
4885 :sort
4886 :substitute
4887 :vglobal
4888 :vimgrep
4889 :vimgrepadd
4890< Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00004891 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You
4892 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the
4893 cursor to the match.
Bram Moolenaardc083282016-10-11 08:57:33 +02004894 You can use the CTRL-G and CTRL-T keys to move to the next and
4895 previous match. |c_CTRL-G| |c_CTRL-T|
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00004896 When compiled with the |+reltime| feature Vim only searches for about
4897 half a second. With a complicated pattern and/or a lot of text the
4898 match may not be found. This is to avoid that Vim hangs while you
4899 are typing the pattern.
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00004900 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'.
Bram Moolenaar2f058492017-11-30 20:27:52 +01004901 When 'hlsearch' is on, all matched strings are highlighted too while
4902 typing a search command. See also: 'hlsearch'.
Bram Moolenaard473c8c2018-08-11 18:00:22 +02004903 If you don't want to turn 'hlsearch' on, but want to highlight all
4904 matches while searching, you can turn on and off 'hlsearch' with
4905 autocmd. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar2e51d9a2017-10-29 16:40:30 +01004906 augroup vimrc-incsearch-highlight
4907 autocmd!
Bram Moolenaarf8f8b2e2017-11-02 19:08:48 +01004908 autocmd CmdlineEnter /,\? :set hlsearch
4909 autocmd CmdlineLeave /,\? :set nohlsearch
Bram Moolenaar2e51d9a2017-10-29 16:40:30 +01004910 augroup END
4911<
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00004912 CTRL-L can be used to add one character from after the current match
Bram Moolenaara9dc3752010-07-11 20:46:53 +02004913 to the command line. If 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase' are set and the
4914 command line has no uppercase characters, the added character is
4915 converted to lowercase.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00004916 CTRL-R CTRL-W can be used to add the word at the end of the current
4917 match, excluding the characters that were already typed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004918 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4919
4920 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'*
4921'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "")
4922 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar8e145b82022-05-21 20:17:31 +01004923 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
4924 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004925 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line.
4926 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and
4927 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option.
4928 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and
Bram Moolenaar20f90cf2011-05-19 12:22:51 +02004929 'smartindent' indenting. When 'lisp' is set, this option is
Dominique Pellédf62c622024-07-15 20:29:59 +02004930 only used when 'lispoptions' contains "expr:1".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004931 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting.
4932 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00004933 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004934 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around).
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00004935
Yegappan Lakshmanan8bb65f22021-12-26 10:51:39 +00004936 If the expression starts with s: or |<SID>|, then it is replaced with
4937 the script ID (|local-function|). Example: >
4938 set indentexpr=s:MyIndentExpr()
4939 set indentexpr=<SID>SomeIndentExpr()
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00004940< Otherwise, the expression is evaluated in the context of the script
4941 where the option was set, thus script-local items are available.
4942
Bram Moolenaara4e0b972022-10-01 19:43:52 +01004943 The advantage of using a function call without arguments is that it is
4944 faster, see |expr-option-function|.
4945
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004946 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It
4947 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is
4948 used for the indent).
4949 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()|
4950 and |lispindent()|.
4951 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must
4952 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the
4953 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved.
4954 Normally this option would be set to call a function: >
4955 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent()
4956< Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains
4957 "msg".
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004958 See |indent-expression|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01004959 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004960
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02004961 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4962 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004963 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004964
4965 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
4966 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|.
4967
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004968 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'*
Bram Moolenaarce655742019-01-31 14:12:57 +01004969'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},0),0],:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004970 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004971 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
4972 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty.
4973 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|.
4974 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|.
4975
4976 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'*
4977'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off)
4978 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004979 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004980 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted depending
4981 on the typed text. If the typed text contains a lowercase letter
4982 where the match has an upper case letter, the completed part is made
4983 lowercase. If the typed text has no lowercase letters and the match
4984 has a lowercase letter where the typed text has an uppercase letter,
4985 and there is a letter before it, the completed part is made uppercase.
4986 With 'noinfercase' the match is used as-is.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004987
glepnirbcd59952025-04-24 21:48:35 +02004988 *'isexpand'* *'ise'*
4989'isexpand' 'ise' string (default: "")
4990 local to buffer
Hirohito Higashifa8b7db2025-04-30 19:12:37 +02004991 Defines characters and patterns for completion in insert mode. Used
4992 by the |complete_match()| function to determine the starting position
4993 for completion. This is a comma-separated list of triggers. Each
4994 trigger can be:
glepnirbcd59952025-04-24 21:48:35 +02004995 - A single character like "." or "/"
4996 - A sequence of characters like "->", "/*", or "/**"
4997
4998 Note: Use "\\," to add a literal comma as trigger character, see
4999 |option-backslash|.
5000
glepnirffc89e42025-04-27 14:59:17 +02005001 Examples: >
5002 set isexpand=.,->,/*,\\,
5003<
5004
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005005 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'*
5006'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off)
5007 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005008 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful
5009 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|.
5010 These Insert mode commands will be useful:
5011 - Use the cursor keys to move around.
Bram Moolenaardc1f1642016-08-16 18:33:43 +02005012 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|. When
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005013 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off.
5014 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005015 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use
Bram Moolenaar488c6512005-08-11 20:09:58 +00005016 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor
5017 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005018
5019 These items change when 'insertmode' is set:
5020 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode.
5021 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps.
5022 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode.
5023 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted.
5024 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z*
5025 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like
5026 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same
5027 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set.
5028 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used.
5029
5030 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
5031
5032 *'isfname'* *'isf'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01005033'isfname' 'isf' string (default for Win32:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005034 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,="
5035 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:"
5036 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~"
5037 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,="
5038 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=")
5039 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005040 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and
5041 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005042 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005043 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
5044 characters up to 255 are specified with this option.
5045 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005046 Think twice before adding white space to this option. Although a
5047 space may appear inside a file name, the effect will be that Vim
5048 doesn't know where a file name starts or ends when doing completion.
5049 It most likely works better without a space in 'isfname'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005050
5051 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to
5052 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit
5053 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special
5054 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file
5055 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The
5056 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for
5057 cmd.exe.
5058
5059 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005060 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two
5061 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005062 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does
5063 not work for digits). Example:
5064 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range
5065 128 to 140 and '#' to 43)
5066 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range
5067 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left
5068 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is
5069 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the
5070 option or the end of a range. Example:
5071 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^')
5072 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE
5073 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z,
5074 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples:
5075 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005076 case ASCII letters.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005077 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character.
5078 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is
5079 expected. Example:
5080 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore.
5081 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example:
5082 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding
5083 comma, plus <Tab>.
5084 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
5085
5086 *'isident'* *'isi'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01005087'isident' 'isi' string (default for Win32:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005088 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
5089 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255")
5090 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005091 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers.
5092 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a
5093 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005094 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02005095 option. For '@' only characters up to 255 are used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005096 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005097 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005098 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead.
5099
5100 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01005101'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for Win32:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005102 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
5103 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255"
5104 Vi default: "@,48-57,_")
5105 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005106 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands:
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005107 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02005108 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For '@'
Bram Moolenaar4c295022021-05-02 17:19:11 +02005109 characters above 255 check the "word" character class (any character
5110 that is not white space or punctuation).
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02005111 For C programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005112 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except
5113 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that
5114 command).
5115 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included.
Bram Moolenaarb8060fe2016-01-19 22:29:28 +01005116 This option also influences syntax highlighting, unless the syntax
5117 uses |:syn-iskeyword|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005118 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5119 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5120
5121 *'isprint'* *'isp'*
Yee Cheng Chin92b59c62024-10-22 21:16:43 +02005122'isprint' 'isp' string (default for Win32 and VMS:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005123 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255")
5124 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005125 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the
5126 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from
5127 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly,
5128 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See
5129 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option.
5130
5131 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters:
5132 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_"
5133 32 - 126 always single characters
5134 127 "^?"
5135 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_"
5136 160 - 254 "| " - "|~"
5137 255 "~?"
5138 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are
5139 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte.
5140 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are
5141 displayed as <xx>.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005142 The SpecialKey highlighting will be used for unprintable characters.
5143 |hl-SpecialKey|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005144
5145 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
5146 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character
5147 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a
5148 replacement character will be shown.
5149 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>.
5150 There is no option to specify these characters.
5151
5152 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'*
5153'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on)
5154 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005155 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command.
5156 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'.
5157 Otherwise only one space is inserted.
5158 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
5159
Yegappan Lakshmanan87018252023-09-20 20:20:04 +02005160 *'jumpoptions'* *'jop'*
5161'jumpoptions' 'jop' string (default "")
5162 global
5163 List of words that change the behavior of the |jumplist|.
5164 stack Make the jumplist behave like the tagstack.
5165 Relative location of entries in the jumplist is
5166 preserved at the cost of discarding subsequent entries
5167 when navigating backwards in the jumplist and then
5168 jumping to a location. |jumplist-stack|
5169
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005170 *'key'*
5171'key' string (default "")
5172 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar996343d2010-07-04 22:20:21 +02005173 {only available when compiled with the |+cryptv|
5174 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005175 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer.
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02005176 See |encryption| and 'cryptmethod'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005177 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed
5178 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: >
5179 :set key=
5180< It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or
5181 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't
5182 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it,
5183 be careful not to make a typing error!
Yee Cheng Chin6ee7b522023-10-01 09:13:22 +02005184 You also cannot use |:set-=|, |:set+=|, |:set^=| on this option to
5185 prevent an attacker from guessing substrings in your key.
Bram Moolenaard58e9292011-02-09 17:07:58 +01005186 You can use "&key" in an expression to detect whether encryption is
5187 enabled. When 'key' is set it returns "*****" (five stars).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005188
5189 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544*
5190'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "")
5191 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005192 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap|
5193 feature}
5194 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|.
5195 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of
5196 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective.
5197 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1
Millyae62fe52024-10-02 19:30:41 +02005198 Only alphanumeric characters, '.', '-' and '_' can be used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005199
5200 *'keymodel'* *'km'*
5201'keymodel' 'km' string (default "")
5202 global
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01005203 List of comma-separated words, which enable special things that keys
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005204 can do. These values can be used:
5205 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either
5206 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being
5207 present in 'selectmode').
5208 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection.
5209 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>,
5210 <PageUp> and <PageDown>.
5211 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
5212
Bram Moolenaar63a2e362022-11-23 20:20:18 +00005213 *'keyprotocol'* *'kpc'*
5214'keyprotocol' 'kpc' string (default: see below)
5215 global
5216 Specifies what keyboard protocol to use depending on the value of
5217 'term'. The supported keyboard protocols names are:
5218 none whatever the terminal uses
5219 mok2 modifyOtherKeys level 2, as supported by xterm
5220 kitty Kitty keyboard protocol, as supported by Kitty
5221
Bram Moolenaara87749e2022-11-30 10:23:17 +00005222 The option value is a list of comma separated items. Each item has
Bram Moolenaar63a2e362022-11-23 20:20:18 +00005223 a pattern that is matched against the 'term' option, a colon and the
5224 protocol name to be used. To illustrate this, the default value would
5225 be set with: >
Christian Brabandtf6ba8de2024-12-28 17:15:05 +01005226 set keyprotocol=kitty:kitty,foot:kitty,ghostty:kitty,wezterm:kitty
5227 set keyprotocol+=xterm:mok2
Bram Moolenaar63a2e362022-11-23 20:20:18 +00005228
Hirohito Higashi195fcc92025-02-01 10:26:58 +01005229< This means that when 'term' contains "kitty, "foot", "ghostty" or
Christian Brabandtf6ba8de2024-12-28 17:15:05 +01005230 "wezterm" somewhere, then the "kitty" protocol is used. When 'term'
5231 contains "xterm" somewhere, then the "mok2" protocol is used.
Bram Moolenaar63a2e362022-11-23 20:20:18 +00005232
5233 The first match is used, thus if you want to have "kitty" use the
5234 kitty protocol, but "badkitty" not, then you should match "badkitty"
5235 first and use the "none" value: >
5236 set keyprotocol=badkitty:none,kitty:kitty
5237<
5238 The option is used after 'term' has been changed. First the termcap
5239 entries are set, possibly using the builtin list, see |builtin-terms|.
5240 Then this option is inspected and if there is a match and a protocol
5241 is specified the following happens:
5242 none Nothing, the regular t_TE and t_TI values remain
5243
5244 mok2 The t_TE value is changed to:
5245 CSI >4;m disables modifyOtherKeys
5246 The t_TI value is changed to:
5247 CSI >4;2m enables modifyOtherKeys
Bram Moolenaara87749e2022-11-30 10:23:17 +00005248 CSI ?4m request the modifyOtherKeys state
Bram Moolenaar63a2e362022-11-23 20:20:18 +00005249
5250 kitty The t_TE value is changed to:
5251 CSI >4;m disables modifyOtherKeys
Bram Moolenaara87749e2022-11-30 10:23:17 +00005252 CSI =0;1u disables the kitty keyboard protocol
Bram Moolenaar63a2e362022-11-23 20:20:18 +00005253 The t_TI value is changed to:
Bram Moolenaara87749e2022-11-30 10:23:17 +00005254 CSI =1;1u enables the kitty keyboard protocol
Bram Moolenaar63a2e362022-11-23 20:20:18 +00005255 CSI ?u request kitty keyboard protocol state
5256 CSI >c request the termresponse
5257
Bram Moolenaarf1dcd142022-12-31 15:30:45 +00005258 If you notice problems, such as characters being displayed that
5259 disappear after `CTRL-L`, you might want to try making this option
5260 empty. Then set the 'term' option to have it take effect: >
5261 set keyprotocol=
5262 let &term = &term
Bram Moolenaarbe4e0162023-02-02 13:59:48 +00005263<
Bram Moolenaar63a2e362022-11-23 20:20:18 +00005264
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005265 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'*
5266'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help",
Bram Moolenaar2ff8b642016-05-24 10:46:45 +02005267 VMS: "help")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005268 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005269 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are
5270 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal
5271 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty
5272 value did this, which is now deprecated.)
Bram Moolenaar2ff8b642016-05-24 10:46:45 +02005273 When the first character is ":", the command is invoked as a Vim
Bram Moolenaarb529cfb2022-07-25 15:42:07 +01005274 Ex command with [count] added as an argument if it is not zero.
Bram Moolenaar2ff8b642016-05-24 10:46:45 +02005275 When "man", "man -s" or an Ex command is used, Vim will automatically
5276 translate a count for the "K" command and pass it as the first
5277 argument. For "man -s" the "-s" is removed when there is no count.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005278 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
5279 Example: >
5280 :set keywordprg=man\ -s
5281< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5282 security reasons.
5283
5284 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358*
5285'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "")
5286 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005287 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
5288 feature}
5289 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005290 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01005291 inserted directly. When in Normal mode the 'langmap' option takes
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005292 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning
5293 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to
5294 be able to execute Normal mode commands.
5295 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are
5296 mapped in Insert mode.
Bram Moolenaarb17893a2020-03-14 08:19:51 +01005297 Also consider setting 'langremap' to off, to prevent 'langmap' from
5298 applying to characters resulting from a mapping.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02005299 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5300 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005301
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00005302 Example (for Greek, in UTF-8): *greek* >
5303 :set langmap=ΑA,ΒB,ΨC,ΔD,ΕE,ΦF,ΓG,ΗH,ΙI,ΞJ,ΚK,ΛL,ΜM,ΝN,ΟO,ΠP,QQ,ΡR,ΣS,ΤT,ΘU,ΩV,WW,ΧX,ΥY,ΖZ,αa,βb,ψc,δd,εe,φf,γg,ηh,ιi,ξj,κk,λl,μm,νn,οo,πp,qq,ρr,σs,τt,θu,ωv,ςw,χx,υy,ζz
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005304< Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): >
5305 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ
5306<
5307 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each
5308 part can be in one of two forms:
5309 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately
5310 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC".
Dominique Pellédf62c622024-07-15 20:29:59 +02005311 2. A list of "from" characters, a semicolon and a list of "to"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005312 characters. Example: "abc;ABC"
5313 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE"
5314 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are
Bram Moolenaar4f4d51a2020-10-11 13:57:40 +02005315 ";", ',', '"', '|' and backslash itself.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005316
5317 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch
5318 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will
5319 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the
5320 langmap mappings) in the following cases:
5321 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings)
5322 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R
5323 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings
5324 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by
5325 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time
5326 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings.
5327 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time!
5328
5329 *'langmenu'* *'lm'*
5330'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "")
5331 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005332 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and
5333 |+multi_lang| features}
5334 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded
5335 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': >
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00005336 "lang/menu_" .. &langmenu .. ".vim"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005337< (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no
5338 matter what $LANG is set to: >
5339 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1
5340< When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00005341 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005342 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use
5343 the English menus: >
5344 :set langmenu=none
5345< This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype
5346 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting
5347 this option has no effect. But you could do this: >
5348 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim
5349 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1
5350 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim
5351< Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself!
5352
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005353 *'langnoremap'* *'lnr'* *'nolangnoremap'* *'nolnr'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02005354'langnoremap' 'lnr' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01005355 global
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01005356 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
5357 feature}
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02005358 This is just like 'langremap' but with the value inverted. It only
5359 exists for backwards compatibility. When setting 'langremap' then
5360 'langnoremap' is set to the inverted value, and the other way around.
5361
5362 *'langremap'* *'lrm'* *'nolangremap'* *'nolrm'*
Bram Moolenaarb17893a2020-03-14 08:19:51 +01005363'langremap' 'lrm' boolean (default on, set to off in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02005364 global
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02005365 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
5366 feature}
5367 When off, setting 'langmap' does not apply to characters resulting from
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01005368 a mapping. This basically means, if you noticed that setting
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02005369 'langmap' disables some of your mappings, try resetting this option.
5370 This option defaults to on for backwards compatibility. Set it off if
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01005371 that works for you to avoid mappings to break.
5372
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005373 *'laststatus'* *'ls'*
5374'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1)
5375 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005376 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a
5377 status line:
5378 0: never
5379 1: only if there are at least two windows
5380 2: always
5381 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several
5382 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line|
5383
5384 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'*
5385'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off)
5386 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005387 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while
5388 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005389 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005390 update use |:redraw|.
Bram Moolenaara57b5532022-06-24 11:48:03 +01005391 This may occasionally cause display errors. It is only meant to be set
5392 temporarily when performing an operation where redrawing may cause
Dominique Pellédf62c622024-07-15 20:29:59 +02005393 flickering or cause a slowdown.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005394
64-bitman88d41ab2025-04-06 17:20:39 +02005395 *'lhistory'* *'lhi'*
5396'lhistory' 'lhi' number (default: 10)
5397 local to window
5398 {only available when compiled with the |+quickfix|
5399 feature}
zeertzjqb71f1302025-04-08 20:29:40 +02005400 Like 'chistory', but for the location list stack associated with a
5401 window. If the option is changed in either the location list window
5402 itself or the window that is associated with the location list stack,
5403 the new value will also be applied to the other one. This means this
5404 value will always be the same for a given location list window and its
5405 corresponding window. See |quickfix-stack| for additional info.
64-bitman88d41ab2025-04-06 17:20:39 +02005406
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005407 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'*
5408'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off)
5409 local to window
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005410 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005411 feature}
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02005412 If on, Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005413 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike
5414 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file,
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02005415 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents.
5416 If 'breakindent' is set, line is visually indented. Then, the value
5417 of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines. This option
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02005418 is not used when the 'wrap' option is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005419 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed
5420 with the right amount of white space.
5421
5422 *'lines'* *E593*
5423'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height)
5424 global
5425 Number of lines of the Vim window.
5426 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00005427 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005428 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
5429 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
5430 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
5431 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can
5432 use this command to get the tallest window possible: >
5433 :set lines=999
Bram Moolenaarf4d11452005-12-02 00:46:37 +00005434< Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000.
Bram Moolenaardc1f1642016-08-16 18:33:43 +02005435 If you get fewer lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005436 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
5437 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up.
5438
5439 *'linespace'* *'lsp'*
5440'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI)
5441 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005442 {only in the GUI}
5443 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font
5444 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other.
5445 When non-zero there is room for underlining.
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00005446 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have
5447 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set
5448 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems
5449 though!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005450
5451 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'*
5452'lisp' boolean (default off)
5453 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005454 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for
5455 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with
5456 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p'
5457 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or
5458 better. Also see 'lispwords'.
5459 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the
5460 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than
5461 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty.
5462 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005463
Bram Moolenaar49846fb2022-10-15 16:05:33 +01005464 *'lispoptions'* *'lop'*
5465'lispoptions' 'lop' string (default "")
5466 local to buffer
5467 Comma-separated list of items that influence the Lisp indenting when
5468 enabled with the |'lisp'| option. Currently only one item is
5469 supported:
5470 expr:1 use 'indentexpr' for Lisp indenting when it is set
5471 expr:0 do not use 'indentexpr' for Lisp indenting (default)
5472 Note that when using 'indentexpr' the `=` operator indents all the
5473 lines, otherwise the first line is not indented (Vi-compatible).
5474
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005475 *'lispwords'* *'lw'*
5476'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long)
Bram Moolenaaraf6c1312014-03-12 18:55:58 +01005477 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar48c3f4e2022-08-08 15:42:38 +01005478 Comma-separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting when
5479 enabled with the |'lisp'| option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005480
5481 *'list'* *'nolist'*
5482'list' boolean (default off)
5483 local to window
Bram Moolenaar113cb512021-11-07 20:27:04 +00005484 List mode: By default show tabs as CTRL-I is displayed, display $
5485 after end of line. Useful to see the difference between tabs and
5486 spaces and for trailing blanks. Further changed by the 'listchars'
5487 option.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005488
5489 The cursor is displayed at the start of the space a Tab character
5490 occupies, not at the end as usual in Normal mode. To get this cursor
5491 position while displaying Tabs with spaces, use: >
Bram Moolenaardd007ed2013-07-09 15:44:17 +02005492 :set list lcs=tab:\ \
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005493<
5494 Note that list mode will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth'
5495 or 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005496 changing the way tabs are displayed.
5497
5498 *'listchars'* *'lcs'*
5499'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$")
Bram Moolenaareed9d462021-02-15 20:38:25 +01005500 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaarf9d5ca12010-08-01 16:13:51 +02005501 Strings to use in 'list' mode and for the |:list| command. It is a
zeertzjq6a8d2e12024-01-17 20:54:49 +01005502 comma-separated list of string settings. *E1511*
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005503 *lcs-eol*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005504 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When
5505 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the
5506 line.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005507 *lcs-tab*
Bram Moolenaar83a52172019-01-16 22:41:54 +01005508 tab:xy[z] Two or three characters to be used to show a tab.
5509 The third character is optional.
5510
5511 tab:xy The 'x' is always used, then 'y' as many times as will
5512 fit. Thus "tab:>-" displays:
5513 >
5514 >-
5515 >--
5516 etc.
5517
5518 tab:xyz The 'z' is always used, then 'x' is prepended, and
5519 then 'y' is used as many times as will fit. Thus
5520 "tab:<->" displays:
5521 >
5522 <>
5523 <->
5524 <-->
5525 etc.
5526
5527 When "tab:" is omitted, a tab is shown as ^I.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005528 *lcs-space*
5529 space:c Character to show for a space. When omitted, spaces
5530 are left blank.
zeertzjqf14b8ba2021-09-10 16:58:30 +02005531 *lcs-multispace*
5532 multispace:c...
Bram Moolenaarbe4e0162023-02-02 13:59:48 +00005533 One or more characters to use cyclically to show for
5534 multiple consecutive spaces. Overrides the "space"
zeertzjqf14b8ba2021-09-10 16:58:30 +02005535 setting, except for single spaces. When omitted, the
5536 "space" setting is used. For example,
5537 `:set listchars=multispace:---+` shows ten consecutive
5538 spaces as:
Bram Moolenaaraca12fd2022-06-07 10:16:15 +01005539 ---+---+-- ~
Bram Moolenaar91478ae2021-02-03 15:58:13 +01005540 *lcs-lead*
5541 lead:c Character to show for leading spaces. When omitted,
zeertzjqf14b8ba2021-09-10 16:58:30 +02005542 leading spaces are blank. Overrides the "space" and
5543 "multispace" settings for leading spaces. You can
5544 combine it with "tab:", for example: >
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01005545 :set listchars+=tab:>-,lead:.
Bram Moolenaaraca12fd2022-06-07 10:16:15 +01005546< *lcs-leadmultispace*
5547 leadmultispace:c...
Bram Moolenaar069a7d52022-06-27 22:16:08 +01005548 Like the |lcs-multispace| value, but for leading
5549 spaces only. Also overrides |lcs-lead| for leading
5550 multiple spaces.
Bram Moolenaar8a3b8052022-06-26 12:21:15 +01005551 `:set listchars=leadmultispace:---+` shows ten
5552 consecutive leading spaces as:
Bram Moolenaaraca12fd2022-06-07 10:16:15 +01005553 ---+---+--XXX ~
5554 Where "XXX" denotes the first non-blank characters in
5555 the line.
5556 *lcs-trail*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005557 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted,
zeertzjqf14b8ba2021-09-10 16:58:30 +02005558 trailing spaces are blank. Overrides the "space" and
5559 "multispace" settings for trailing spaces.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005560 *lcs-extends*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005561 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is
5562 off and the line continues beyond the right of the
5563 screen.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005564 *lcs-precedes*
Bram Moolenaarbffba7f2019-09-20 17:00:17 +02005565 precedes:c Character to show in the first visible column of the
5566 physical line, when there is text preceding the
5567 character visible in the first column.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005568 *lcs-conceal*
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02005569 conceal:c Character to show in place of concealed text, when
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02005570 'conceallevel' is set to 1.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005571 *lcs-nbsp*
Bram Moolenaar73284b92015-05-04 17:28:22 +02005572 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space character
5573 (0xA0 (160 decimal) and U+202F). Left blank when
5574 omitted.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005575
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005576 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005577 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable
zeertzjq6a8d2e12024-01-17 20:54:49 +01005578 characters are allowed. All characters must be single width. *E1512*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005579
Bram Moolenaar93ff6722021-10-16 17:51:40 +01005580 Each character can be specified as hex: >
5581 set listchars=eol:\\x24
5582 set listchars=eol:\\u21b5
5583 set listchars=eol:\\U000021b5
5584< Note that a double backslash is used. The number of hex characters
5585 must be exactly 2 for \\x, 4 for \\u and 8 for \\U.
5586
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005587 Examples: >
5588 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:-
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00005589 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:%
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005590 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:<
5591< The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and
Bram Moolenaar34cc7d82021-09-21 20:09:51 +02005592 "precedes". "SpecialKey" will be used for "tab", "nbsp", "space",
5593 "multispace", "lead" and "trail".
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005594 |hl-NonText| |hl-SpecialKey|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005595
5596 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'*
5597'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on)
5598 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005599 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|.
5600 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading
5601 of plugins.
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02005602 Note that using the "-u NONE", "-u DEFAULTS" and "--noplugin" command
5603 line arguments reset this option. See |-u| and |--noplugin|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005604
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005605 *'luadll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005606'luadll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005607 global
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005608 {only available when compiled with the |+lua/dyn|
5609 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005610 Specifies the name of the Lua shared library. The default is
5611 DYNAMIC_LUA_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005612 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005613 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5614 security reasons.
5615
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +00005616 *'macatsui'* *'nomacatsui'*
5617'macatsui' boolean (default on)
5618 global
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02005619 {not supported}
5620 No longer supported, as the Mac OS X GUI code was removed.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005621
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005622 *'magic'* *'nomagic'*
5623'magic' boolean (default on)
5624 global
5625 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns.
5626 See |pattern|.
Bram Moolenaar64d8e252016-09-06 22:12:34 +02005627 WARNING: Switching this option off most likely breaks plugins! That
5628 is because many patterns assume it's on and will fail when it's off.
5629 Only switch it off when working with old Vi scripts. In any other
5630 situation write patterns that work when 'magic' is on. Include "\M"
5631 when you want to |/\M|.
Bram Moolenaar4072ba52020-12-23 13:56:35 +01005632 In |Vim9| script the value of 'magic' is ignored, patterns behave like
5633 it is always set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005634
5635 *'makeef'* *'mef'*
5636'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "")
5637 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005638 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
5639 feature}
5640 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|)
5641 and the |:grep| command.
5642 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used.
5643 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name
5644 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an
5645 existing file.
5646 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that.
5647 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5648 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
5649 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5650 security reasons.
5651
Bram Moolenaar2c7292d2017-03-05 17:43:31 +01005652 *'makeencoding'* *'menc'*
5653'makeencoding' 'menc' string (default "")
5654 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar2c7292d2017-03-05 17:43:31 +01005655 Encoding used for reading the output of external commands. When empty,
5656 encoding is not converted.
5657 This is used for `:make`, `:lmake`, `:grep`, `:lgrep`, `:grepadd`,
5658 `:lgrepadd`, `:cfile`, `:cgetfile`, `:caddfile`, `:lfile`, `:lgetfile`,
5659 and `:laddfile`.
5660
5661 This would be mostly useful when you use MS-Windows and set 'encoding'
5662 to "utf-8". If |+iconv| is enabled and GNU libiconv is used, setting
5663 'makeencoding' to "char" has the same effect as setting to the system
5664 locale encoding. Example: >
5665 :set encoding=utf-8
5666 :set makeencoding=char " system locale is used
5667<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005668 *'makeprg'* *'mp'*
5669'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS")
5670 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005671 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01005672 This option may contain '%' and '#' characters (see |:_%| and |:_#|),
5673 which are expanded to the current and alternate file name. Use |::S|
Bram Moolenaar26df0922014-02-23 23:39:13 +01005674 to escape file names in case they contain special characters.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005675 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
5676 about including spaces and backslashes.
5677 Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set" and once for
5678 the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter called
5679 "myfilter" do it like this: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005680 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter
5681< The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify
5682 where the arguments will be included, for example: >
5683 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*}
5684< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5685 security reasons.
5686
5687 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'*
5688'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]")
5689 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005690 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the
Bram Moolenaara3e6bc92013-01-30 14:18:00 +01005691 other.
5692 Only character pairs are allowed that are different, thus you cannot
5693 jump between two double quotes.
5694 The characters must be separated by a colon.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005695 The pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02005696 '>' (for HTML): >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005697 :set mps+=<:>
5698
5699< A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an
5700 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: >
5701 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:;
5702
5703< For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +01005704 the $VIMRUNTIME/pack/dist/opt/matchit directory. |add-local-help|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005705
5706 *'matchtime'* *'mat'*
5707'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5)
5708 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005709 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is
5710 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that
5711 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi.
5712
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00005713 *'maxcombine'* *'mco'*
5714'maxcombine' 'mco' number (default 2)
5715 global
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00005716 The maximum number of combining characters supported for displaying.
5717 Only used when 'encoding' is "utf-8".
5718 The default is OK for most languages. Hebrew may require 4.
5719 Maximum value is 6.
5720 Even when this option is set to 2 you can still edit text with more
5721 combining characters, you just can't see them. Use |g8| or |ga|.
5722 See |mbyte-combining|.
5723
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005724 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'*
5725'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100)
5726 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005727 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005728 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005729 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally
5730 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with
5731 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use
5732 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted.
Bram Moolenaarbc2eada2017-01-02 21:27:47 +01005733 Increasing this limit above 200 also changes the maximum for Ex
Bram Moolenaar0b0f0992018-05-22 21:41:30 +02005734 command recursion, see |E169|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005735 See also |:function|.
zeertzjqfe583b12023-12-21 16:59:26 +01005736 Also used for maximum depth of callback functions.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005737
5738 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223*
5739'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000)
5740 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005741 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a
5742 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like
5743 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg",
5744 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also
5745 |key-mapping|.
5746
5747 *'maxmem'* *'mm'*
5748'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system
5749 dependent) or half the amount of memory
5750 available)
5751 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005752 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this
5753 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01005754 other memory to be freed.
5755 The maximum usable value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a
5756 limit.
5757 The value is ignored when 'swapfile' is off.
5758 Also see 'maxmemtot'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005759
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005760 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'*
5761'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000)
5762 global
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005763 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005764 The maximum value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a limit.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005765 *E363*
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005766 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message and mostly
5767 behaves like CTRL-C was typed.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005768 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very
5769 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern
5770 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better.
Bram Moolenaarfd358112018-07-07 23:21:31 +02005771 Might also happen on redraw, when syntax rules try to match a complex
5772 text structure.
5773 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit, in
5774 which case you get an "Out of memory" error instead.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005775
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005776 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'*
5777'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system
5778 dependent) or half the amount of memory
5779 available)
5780 global
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005781 Maximum amount of memory in Kbyte to use for all buffers together.
5782 The maximum usable value is about 2000000 (2 Gbyte). Use this to work
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01005783 without a limit.
5784 On 64 bit machines higher values might work. But hey, do you really
5785 need more than 2 Gbyte for text editing? Keep in mind that text is
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005786 stored in the swap file, one can edit files > 2 Gbyte anyway. We do
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01005787 need the memory to store undo info.
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01005788 Buffers with 'swapfile' off still count to the total amount of memory
5789 used.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005790 Also see 'maxmem'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005791
5792 *'menuitems'* *'mis'*
5793'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25)
5794 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005795 {not available when compiled without the |+menu|
5796 feature}
5797 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are
5798 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this
5799 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first.
5800
Christian Brabandt51d4d842024-12-06 17:26:25 +01005801 *'messagesopt'* *'mopt'*
5802'messagesopt' 'mopt' string (default "hit-enter,history:500")
5803 global
5804
zeertzjq8cc43da2024-12-07 16:09:08 +01005805 Option settings for outputting messages. It can consist of the
Christian Brabandt51d4d842024-12-06 17:26:25 +01005806 following items. Items must be separated by a comma.
5807
zeertzjq8cc43da2024-12-07 16:09:08 +01005808 hit-enter Use a |hit-enter| prompt when the message is longer than
Christian Brabandt51d4d842024-12-06 17:26:25 +01005809 'cmdheight' size.
5810
zeertzjq8cc43da2024-12-07 16:09:08 +01005811 wait:{n} Instead of using a |hit-enter| prompt, simply wait for
5812 {n} milliseconds so that the user has a chance to read
5813 the message. The maximum value of {n} is 10000. Use
5814 0 to disable the wait (but then the user may miss an
5815 important message).
5816 This item is ignored when "hit-enter" is present, but
5817 required when "hit-enter" is not present.
Christian Brabandt51d4d842024-12-06 17:26:25 +01005818
5819 history:{n} Determines how many entries are remembered in the
5820 |:messages| history. The maximum value is 10000.
5821 Setting it to zero clears the message history.
zeertzjq8cc43da2024-12-07 16:09:08 +01005822 This item must always be present.
Christian Brabandt51d4d842024-12-06 17:26:25 +01005823
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00005824 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'*
5825'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500")
5826 global
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00005827 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
5828 feature}
5829 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the
5830 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but
5831 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used
5832 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why
5833 this tuning is complicated.
5834
5835 There are three numbers, separated by commas:
5836 {start},{inc},{added}
5837
5838 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start}
5839 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any
5840 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of
5841 memory that is available to Vim.
5842
5843 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the
5844 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another
5845 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after
5846 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory
5847 will be allocated.
5848
5849 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before
5850 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra
5851 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller
5852 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's
5853 slower.
5854
5855 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and
5856 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If
5857 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: >
5858 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800
5859< If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some
5860 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to.
5861
dkearns8ebdbc92023-10-29 06:26:19 +11005862 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5863 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar07607392019-05-26 19:20:43 +02005864
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005865 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'*
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +00005866'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on (off for root),
5867 Vi default: off)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005868 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02005869 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
5870 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
5871 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
5872
5873 *'modelineexpr'* *'mle'* *'nomodelineexpr'* *'nomle'*
5874'modelineexpr' 'mle' boolean (default: off)
5875 global
5876 When on allow some options that are an expression to be set in the
5877 modeline. Check the option for whether it is affected by
5878 'modelineexpr'. Also see |modeline|.
Bram Moolenaar1c6fd1e2019-05-23 22:11:59 +02005879 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5880 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02005881
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005882 *'modelines'* *'mls'*
5883'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5)
5884 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005885 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
5886 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
5887 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
5888 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5889 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5890
5891 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'*
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02005892 *E21*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005893'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on)
5894 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005895 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and
5896 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed.
Bram Moolenaar369b6f52017-01-17 12:22:32 +01005897 Can be reset on startup with the |-M| command line argument.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005898
5899 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'*
5900'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off)
Christian Brabandt596ad662023-08-16 00:11:09 +02005901 local to buffer |local-noglobal|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005902 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set
5903 when:
5904 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the
5905 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the
5906 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the
5907 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from
5908 when it was written.
5909 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original
5910 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or
5911 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original
5912 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be
5913 reset.
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01005914 Similarly for 'eol' and 'bomb'.
Bram Moolenaar5302d9e2011-09-14 17:55:08 +02005915 This option is not set when a change is made to the buffer as the
5916 result of a BufNewFile, BufRead/BufReadPost, BufWritePost,
5917 FileAppendPost or VimLeave autocommand event. See |gzip-example| for
5918 an explanation.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005919 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but
5920 will be ignored.
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01005921 Note that the text may actually be the same, e.g. 'modified' is set
5922 when using "rA" on an "A".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005923
5924 *'more'* *'nomore'*
5925'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
5926 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005927 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get
5928 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the
5929 listing continues until finished.
5930 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5931 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5932
Bram Moolenaar98a29d02021-01-18 19:55:44 +01005933 *'mouse'*
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01005934'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI and Win32,
Bram Moolenaar5b418992019-10-27 18:50:25 +01005935 set to "a" or "nvi" in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005936 global
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01005937 Enable the use of the mouse. Works for most terminals (xterm, Win32
5938 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, *BSD console with sysmouse and Linux console
5939 with gpm). For using the mouse in the GUI, see |gui-mouse|. The
5940 mouse can be enabled for different modes:
Bram Moolenaar7f2e9d72017-11-11 20:58:53 +01005941 n Normal mode and Terminal modes
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005942 v Visual mode
5943 i Insert mode
5944 c Command-line mode
5945 h all previous modes when editing a help file
5946 a all previous modes
5947 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02005948 Normally you would enable the mouse in all five modes with: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005949 :set mouse=a
Bram Moolenaar5b418992019-10-27 18:50:25 +01005950< If your terminal can't overrule the mouse events going to the
5951 application, use: >
5952 :set mouse=nvi
Bram Moolenaar65e0d772020-06-14 17:29:55 +02005953< Then you can press ":", select text for the system, and press Esc to go
Bram Moolenaar5b418992019-10-27 18:50:25 +01005954 back to Vim using the mouse events.
5955 In |defaults.vim| "nvi" is used if the 'term' option is not matching
5956 "xterm".
5957
5958 When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005959 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor.
5960
5961 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|.
5962
5963 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005964 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005965 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed.
5966 Also see the 'clipboard' option.
5967
5968 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'*
5969'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off)
5970 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005971 {only works in the GUI}
5972 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated.
5973 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the
5974 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the
5975 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as
5976 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally.
Bram Moolenaar5ef1c6a2019-11-10 22:09:11 +01005977 MS-Windows: Also see 'scrollfocus' for what window is scrolled when
Bram Moolenaar1d9215b2020-01-25 13:27:42 +01005978 using the mouse scroll wheel.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005979
5980 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'*
5981'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on)
5982 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005983 {only works in the GUI}
5984 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed.
5985 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved.
5986
5987 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'*
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01005988'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for Win32)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005989 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005990 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what
5991 the right mouse button is used for:
5992 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works
5993 like in an xterm.
5994 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left
5995 mouse button extends a selection. This works like
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005996 with Microsoft Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005997 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the
5998 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the
5999 selected operation will act upon the clicked object.
6000 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006001 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006002 course, that right clicking outside a selection will
6003 end Visual mode.
6004 Overview of what button does what for each model:
6005 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~
6006 left click place cursor place cursor
6007 left drag start selection start selection
6008 shift-left search word extend selection
6009 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor)
6010 right drag extend selection -
6011 middle click paste paste
6012
6013 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu.
6014 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|.
6015
6016 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings.
6017 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless
6018 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly).
6019
6020 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
6021
h_east59858792023-10-25 22:47:05 +09006022 *'mousemoveevent'* *'mousemev'* *'nomousemoveevent'* *'nomousemev'*
Ernie Raelc4cb5442022-04-03 15:47:28 +01006023'mousemoveevent' 'mousemev' boolean (default off)
6024 global
6025 {only works in the GUI}
6026 When on, mouse move events are delivered to the input queue and are
6027 available for mapping. The default, off, avoids the mouse movement
6028 overhead except when needed. See |gui-mouse-mapping|.
6029 Warning: Setting this option can make pending mappings to be aborted
6030 when the mouse is moved.
6031 Currently only works in the GUI, may be made to work in a terminal
6032 later.
6033
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006034 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547*
Bram Moolenaarf6b40102019-02-22 15:24:03 +01006035'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i-r:beam,s:updown,sd:udsizing,
6036 vs:leftright,vd:lrsizing,m:no,
6037 ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006038 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006039 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape|
6040 feature}
6041 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01006042 different modes. The option is a comma-separated list of parts, much
Drew Vogel48b19b22025-05-07 21:32:03 +02006043 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consists of a mode/location-list
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006044 and an argument-list:
6045 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,..
6046 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations:
6047 In a normal window: ~
6048 n Normal mode
6049 v Visual mode
6050 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
6051 if not specified)
6052 o Operator-pending mode
6053 i Insert mode
6054 r Replace mode
6055
6056 Others: ~
6057 c appending to the command-line
6058 ci inserting in the command-line
6059 cr replacing in the command-line
6060 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts
6061 ml idem, but cursor in the last line
6062 e any mode, pointer below last window
6063 s any mode, pointer on a status line
6064 sd any mode, while dragging a status line
6065 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line
6066 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line
6067 a everywhere
6068
6069 The shape is one of the following:
6070 avail name looks like ~
Drew Vogel48b19b22025-05-07 21:32:03 +02006071 w x g arrow Normal mouse pointer
6072 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!)
6073 w x g beam I-beam
6074 w x g updown up-down sizing arrows
6075 w x g leftright left-right sizing arrows
6076 w x g busy The system's usual busy pointer
6077 w x g no The system's usual 'no input' pointer
6078 x g udsizing indicates up-down resizing
6079 x g lrsizing indicates left-right resizing
6080 x g crosshair like a big thin +
6081 x g hand1 black hand
6082 x g hand2 white hand
6083 x pencil what you write with
6084 x g question big ?
6085 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up
6086 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006087 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h)
6088
6089 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32,
Drew Vogel48b19b22025-05-07 21:32:03 +02006090 x for X11 (including GTK+ 2), g for GTK+ 3.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006091 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse
6092 pointer.
6093
6094 Example: >
6095 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no
6096< will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and
6097 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since
6098 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.)
6099
6100 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'*
6101'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500)
6102 global
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01006103 Only for GUI, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006104 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be
6105 recognized as a multi click.
6106
Shougo Matsushita4bd9b2b2024-11-14 22:31:48 +01006107
laburnumT3f7855a2023-12-05 18:37:03 +01006108 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'*
6109'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100)
6110 global
6111 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme|
6112 feature}
6113 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads.
6114 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling.
6115 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
6116 is reset.
6117
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02006118 *'mzschemedll'*
6119'mzschemedll' string (default depends on the build)
6120 global
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02006121 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn|
6122 feature}
6123 Specifies the name of the MzScheme shared library. The default is
6124 DYNAMIC_MZSCH_DLL which was specified at compile time.
6125 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaarb0d45e72017-11-05 18:19:24 +01006126 The value must be set in the |vimrc| script or earlier. In the
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +01006127 startup, before the |load-plugins| step.
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02006128 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6129 security reasons.
6130
6131 *'mzschemegcdll'*
6132'mzschemegcdll' string (default depends on the build)
6133 global
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02006134 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn|
6135 feature}
6136 Specifies the name of the MzScheme GC shared library. The default is
6137 DYNAMIC_MZGC_DLL which was specified at compile time.
6138 The value can be equal to 'mzschemedll' if it includes the GC code.
6139 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
6140 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6141 security reasons.
6142
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006143 *'nrformats'* *'nf'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02006144'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "bin,octal,hex",
6145 set to "bin,hex" in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006146 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006147 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the
6148 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number
6149 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands.
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00006150 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006151 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01006152 letter index a), b), etc. *octal-nrformats*
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00006153 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006154 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010".
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00006155 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006156 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on
6157 "0x100" results in "0x0ff".
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006158 bin If included, numbers starting with "0b" or "0B" will be
6159 considered to be binary. Example: Using CTRL-X on
6160 "0b1000" subtracts one, resulting in "0b0111".
Bram Moolenaaraaad9952020-05-31 15:08:59 +02006161 unsigned If included, numbers are recognized as unsigned. Thus a
6162 leading dash or negative sign won't be considered as part of
6163 the number. Examples:
6164 Using CTRL-X on "2020" in "9-2020" results in "9-2019"
6165 (without "unsigned" it would become "9-2021").
6166 Using CTRL-A on "2020" in "9-2020" results in "9-2021"
6167 (without "unsigned" it would become "9-2019").
Bram Moolenaaracc22402020-06-07 21:07:18 +02006168 Using CTRL-X on "0" or CTRL-A on "18446744073709551615"
6169 (2^64 - 1) has no effect, overflow is prevented.
distobs25ac6d62024-07-06 17:50:09 +02006170 blank If included, treat numbers as signed or unsigned based on
h-east52e7cc22024-07-28 17:03:29 +02006171 preceding whitespace. If a number with a leading dash has its
distobs25ac6d62024-07-06 17:50:09 +02006172 dash immediately preceded by a non-whitespace character (i.e.,
6173 not a tab or a " "), the negative sign won't be considered as
6174 part of the number. For example:
6175 Using CTRL-A on "14" in "Carbon-14" results in "Carbon-15"
6176 (without "blank" it would become "Carbon-13").
6177 Using CTRL-X on "8" in "Carbon -8" results in "Carbon -9"
h-east52e7cc22024-07-28 17:03:29 +02006178 (because -8 is preceded by whitespace. If "unsigned" was
distobs25ac6d62024-07-06 17:50:09 +02006179 set, it would result in "Carbon -7").
6180 If this format is included, overflow is prevented as if
h-east52e7cc22024-07-28 17:03:29 +02006181 "unsigned" were set. If both this format and "unsigned" are
distobs25ac6d62024-07-06 17:50:09 +02006182 included, "unsigned" will take precedence.
6183
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006184 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always
6185 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not
6186 recognized as octal or hex.
6187
6188 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'*
6189'number' 'nu' boolean (default off)
6190 local to window
6191 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is
6192 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of
6193 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set).
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00006194 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
6195 number.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006196 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
6197 characters are put before the number.
James McCoya80aad72021-12-22 19:45:28 +00006198 For highlighting see |hl-LineNr|, and |hl-CursorLineNr|, and the
6199 |:sign-define| "numhl" argument.
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02006200 *number_relativenumber*
6201 The 'relativenumber' option changes the displayed number to be
6202 relative to the cursor. Together with 'number' there are these
6203 four combinations (cursor in line 3):
6204
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01006205 'nonu' 'nu' 'nonu' 'nu'
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02006206 'nornu' 'nornu' 'rnu' 'rnu'
6207
6208 |apple | 1 apple | 2 apple | 2 apple
6209 |pear | 2 pear | 1 pear | 1 pear
6210 |nobody | 3 nobody | 0 nobody |3 nobody
6211 |there | 4 there | 1 there | 1 there
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006212
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00006213 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'*
6214'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8)
6215 local to window
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00006216 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak|
6217 feature}
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00006218 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006219 when the 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set or printing lines
6220 with a line number. Since one space is always between the number and
6221 the text, there is one less character for the number itself.
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00006222 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006223 fit the highest line number in the buffer respectively the number of
6224 rows in the window, depending on whether 'number' or 'relativenumber'
6225 is set. Thus with the Vim default of 4 there is room for a line number
6226 up to 999. When the buffer has 1000 lines five columns will be used.
Bram Moolenaarf8a07122019-07-01 22:06:07 +02006227 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 20.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01006228 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
6229 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00006230
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +00006231 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'*
6232'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty)
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00006233 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02006234 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
Bram Moolenaare2c453d2019-08-21 14:37:09 +02006235 feature}
Bram Moolenaarc7486e02005-12-29 22:48:26 +00006236 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni
6237 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00006238 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
Yegappan Lakshmanan8658c752021-12-03 11:09:29 +00006239 invoked and what it should return. The value can be the name of a
6240 function, a |lambda| or a |Funcref|. See |option-value-function| for
6241 more information.
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00006242 This option is usually set by a filetype plugin:
Bram Moolenaar9c102382006-05-03 21:26:49 +00006243 |:filetype-plugin-on|
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02006244 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6245 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00006246
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00006247 *'opendevice'* *'odev'* *'noopendevice'* *'noodev'*
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00006248'opendevice' 'odev' boolean (default off)
6249 global
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00006250 {only for MS-Windows} *E796*
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00006251 Enable reading and writing from devices. This may get Vim stuck on a
6252 device that can be opened but doesn't actually do the I/O. Therefore
6253 it is off by default.
6254 Note that on MS-Windows editing "aux.h", "lpt1.txt" and the like also
6255 result in editing a device.
6256
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00006257 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'*
6258'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty)
6259 global
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00006260 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator.
Yegappan Lakshmanan777175b2021-11-18 22:08:57 +00006261 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example. The value can be
6262 the name of a function, a |lambda| or a |Funcref|. See
6263 |option-value-function| for more information.
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00006264
6265 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6266 security reasons.
6267
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02006268 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'*
6269'osfiletype' 'oft' string (default: "")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006270 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02006271 This option was supported on RISC OS, which has been removed.
6272
Bram Moolenaarf6fee0e2016-02-21 23:02:49 +01006273 *'packpath'* *'pp'*
6274'packpath' 'pp' string (default: see 'runtimepath')
Bram Moolenaarf6fee0e2016-02-21 23:02:49 +01006275 Directories used to find packages. See |packages|.
dkearns8ebdbc92023-10-29 06:26:19 +11006276 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6277 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaarf6fee0e2016-02-21 23:02:49 +01006278
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006279 *'paragraphs'* *'para'*
Bram Moolenaar57e48462008-03-12 16:38:55 +00006280'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP TPHPLIPpLpItpplpipbp")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006281 global
6282 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs
6283 of two letters (see |object-motions|).
6284
6285 *'paste'* *'nopaste'*
6286'paste' boolean (default off)
6287 global
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006288 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy
6289 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006290 unexpected effects.
6291 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006292 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006293 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste'
6294 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the
6295 mouse clicks itself.
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00006296 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in
6297 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting
6298 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button
6299 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006300 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on):
6301 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled
6302 - abbreviations are disabled
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006303 - 'autoindent' is reset
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006304 - 'expandtab' is reset
Bram Moolenaar4d8f4762021-06-27 15:18:56 +02006305 - 'hkmap' is reset
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006306 - 'revins' is reset
6307 - 'ruler' is reset
6308 - 'showmatch' is reset
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006309 - 'smarttab' is reset
6310 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0
6311 - 'textwidth' is set to 0
6312 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0
Bram Moolenaar4d8f4762021-06-27 15:18:56 +02006313 - 'varsofttabstop' is made empty
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006314 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006315 - 'cindent'
Bram Moolenaar4d8f4762021-06-27 15:18:56 +02006316 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006317 - 'indentexpr'
6318 - 'lisp'
Bram Moolenaar4d8f4762021-06-27 15:18:56 +02006319 - 'smartindent'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006320 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is
6321 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the
6322 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to
6323 set the 'paste' option again.
6324 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to
6325 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on.
6326 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect.
6327 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use
6328 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key.
6329
6330 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'*
6331'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "")
6332 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006333 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste'
6334 option. This is like specifying a mapping: >
6335 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR>
6336< Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'.
6337 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set.
6338 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in
6339 Command-line mode.
6340 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However,
6341 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do
6342 this: >
6343 :map <F10> :set paste<CR>
6344 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR>
6345 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR>
6346 :imap <F11> <nop>
6347 :set pastetoggle=<F11>
6348< This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode.
6349 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste
6350 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key
6351 sequence.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00006352 When the value has several bytes 'ttimeoutlen' applies.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006353
6354 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'*
6355'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "")
6356 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006357 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
6358 feature}
6359 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006360 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|.
dkearns8ebdbc92023-10-29 06:26:19 +11006361 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6362 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006363
Bram Moolenaardbc28022014-07-26 13:40:44 +02006364 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E205* *E206*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006365'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "")
6366 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006367 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used
6368 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a
6369 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a
6370 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the
6371 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option
6372 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like
Bram Moolenaardf980db2017-12-24 13:22:00 +01006373 ".orig" or ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work
6374 (Detail: The backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the
6375 new file has been successfully written, that's why it must be possible
6376 to write a backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an
6377 empty file is created.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006378 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made.
6379 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the
6380 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always
6381 recognized as a compressed file.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00006382 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006383
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01006384 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347* *E854*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006385'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,,"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006386 other systems: ".,,")
6387 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006388 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00006389 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find|, |:sfind|, |:tabfind| and other commands,
6390 provided that the file being searched for has a relative path (not
6391 starting with "/", "./" or "../"). The directories in the 'path'
6392 option may be relative or absolute.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006393 - Use commas to separate directory names: >
6394 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include
6395< - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards
6396 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory
6397 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: >
6398 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space
6399< - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra
6400 backslash: >
6401 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma
6402< - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: >
6403 :set path=.
6404< - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two
6405 commas: >
6406 :set path=,,
6407< - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'.
6408 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
6409 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding
6410 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work.
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00006411 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree using "*", "**" and
6412 ";". See |file-searching| for info and syntax.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006413 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: >
6414 :set path=.,c:\\include
6415< Or just use '/' instead: >
6416 :set path=.,c:/include
6417< Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as
6418 the file!
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006419 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006420 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
6421 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of
6422 'path', see |:checkpath|.
6423 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
6424 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
6425 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: >
6426 :set path-=
6427< To add the current directory use: >
6428 :set path+=
6429< To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the
6430 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory
Dominique Pellédf62c622024-07-15 20:29:59 +02006431 names are separated with a semicolon: >
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00006432 :let &path = &path .. "," .. substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g')
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006433< Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that
6434 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space.
6435
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +02006436 *'perldll'*
6437'perldll' string (default depends on the build)
6438 global
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +02006439 {only available when compiled with the |+perl/dyn|
6440 feature}
6441 Specifies the name of the Perl shared library. The default is
6442 DYNAMIC_PERL_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
6443 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
6444 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6445 security reasons.
6446
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006447 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'*
6448'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off)
6449 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006450 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the
6451 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a
6452 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is
6453 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option
6454 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible
6455 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00006456 'expandtab' does not apply to the preserved white space, a Tab remains
6457 a Tab.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006458 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of
6459 tabs and spaces. You might not like this.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01006460 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006461 Also see 'copyindent'.
6462 Use |:retab| to clean up white space.
6463
6464 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'*
6465'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12)
6466 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02006467 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
6468 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006469 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated
Bram Moolenaar79648732019-07-18 21:43:07 +02006470 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given. Not used when
6471 'previewpopup' is set.
6472
6473 *'previewpopup'* *'pvp'*
6474'previewpopup' 'pvp' string (default empty)
6475 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02006476 {not available when compiled without the |+textprop|
6477 or |+quickfix| feature}
Bram Moolenaar79648732019-07-18 21:43:07 +02006478 When not empty a popup window is used for commands that would open a
6479 preview window. See |preview-popup|.
Bram Moolenaar576a4a62019-08-18 15:25:17 +02006480 Not used for the insert completion info, add "popup" to
6481 'completeopt' for that.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006482
6483 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'*
6484 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590*
6485'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off)
Christian Brabandt596ad662023-08-16 00:11:09 +02006486 local to window |local-noglobal|
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02006487 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
6488 feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006489 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006490 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands
6491 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc.
6492
6493 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'*
6494'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty)
6495 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006496 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
6497 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006498 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|.
6499 See |pdev-option|.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00006500 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6501 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006502
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006503 *'printencoding'* *'penc'*
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02006504'printencoding' 'penc' string (default empty, except for some systems)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006505 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006506 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
6507 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006508 Sets the character encoding used when printing.
6509 See |penc-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006510
6511 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'*
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02006512'printexpr' 'pexpr' string (default: see below)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006513 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006514 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
6515 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006516 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|.
6517 See |pexpr-option|.
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +01006518 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6519 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006520
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006521 *'printfont'* *'pfn'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006522'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier")
6523 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006524 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
6525 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006526 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|.
6527 See |pfn-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006528
6529 *'printheader'* *'pheader'*
6530'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N")
6531 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006532 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
6533 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006534 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output.
6535 See |pheader-option|.
6536
6537 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'*
6538'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "")
6539 global
Bram Moolenaar4c92e752019-02-17 21:18:32 +01006540 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
6541 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006542 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
6543 See |pmbcs-option|.
6544
6545 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'*
6546'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "")
6547 global
Bram Moolenaar4c92e752019-02-17 21:18:32 +01006548 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
6549 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006550 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
6551 See |pmbfn-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006552
6553 *'printoptions'* *'popt'*
6554'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "")
6555 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006556 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006557 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|.
6558 See |popt-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006559
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006560 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'*
6561'prompt' boolean (default on)
6562 global
6563 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode.
6564
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00006565 *'pumheight'* *'ph'*
6566'pumheight' 'ph' number (default 0)
6567 global
Bram Moolenaar06a89a52006-04-29 22:01:03 +00006568 Determines the maximum number of items to show in the popup menu for
6569 Insert mode completion. When zero as much space as available is used.
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00006570 |ins-completion-menu|.
6571
glepnir88d75932025-03-27 20:09:07 +01006572 *'pummaxwidth'* *'pmw'*
6573'pummaxwidth' 'pmw' number (default 0)
6574 global
6575 Determines the maximum width to use for the popup menu for completion.
6576 When zero, there is no maximum width limit, otherwise the popup menu
6577 will never be wider than this value. Truncated text will be indicated
glepnirb8762042025-04-07 20:57:14 +02006578 by "trunc" value of 'fillchars' option.
6579
6580 This option takes precedence over 'pumwidth'.
glepnir88d75932025-03-27 20:09:07 +01006581 |ins-completion-menu|.
6582
Bram Moolenaara8f04aa2018-02-10 15:36:55 +01006583 *'pumwidth'* *'pw'*
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01006584'pumwidth' 'pw' number (default 15)
Bram Moolenaara8f04aa2018-02-10 15:36:55 +01006585 global
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01006586 Determines the minimum width to use for the popup menu for Insert mode
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01006587 completion. |ins-completion-menu|.
Bram Moolenaara8f04aa2018-02-10 15:36:55 +01006588
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006589 *'pythondll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01006590'pythondll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006591 global
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006592 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn|
6593 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006594 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x shared library. The default is
6595 DYNAMIC_PYTHON_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02006596 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006597 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6598 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00006599
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01006600 *'pythonhome'*
6601'pythonhome' string (default "")
6602 global
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01006603 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn|
6604 feature}
6605 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x home directory. When 'pythonhome'
6606 and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set, PYTHON_HOME,
6607 which was specified at compile time, will be used for the Python 2.x
6608 home directory.
6609 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
6610 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6611 security reasons.
6612
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01006613 *'pythonthreedll'*
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006614'pythonthreedll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01006615 global
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01006616 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn|
6617 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006618 Specifies the name of the Python 3 shared library. The default is
6619 DYNAMIC_PYTHON3_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02006620 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01006621 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6622 security reasons.
6623
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01006624 *'pythonthreehome'*
6625'pythonthreehome' string (default "")
6626 global
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01006627 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn|
6628 feature}
6629 Specifies the name of the Python 3 home directory. When
6630 'pythonthreehome' and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set,
6631 PYTHON3_HOME, which was specified at compile time, will be used for
6632 the Python 3 home directory.
6633 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
6634 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6635 security reasons.
6636
Bram Moolenaarf42dd3c2017-01-28 16:06:38 +01006637 *'pyxversion'* *'pyx'*
6638'pyxversion' 'pyx' number (default depends on the build)
6639 global
Bram Moolenaarf42dd3c2017-01-28 16:06:38 +01006640 {only available when compiled with the |+python| or
6641 the |+python3| feature}
6642 Specifies the python version used for pyx* functions and commands
6643 |python_x|. The default value is as follows:
6644
6645 Compiled with Default ~
6646 |+python| and |+python3| 0
6647 only |+python| 2
6648 only |+python3| 3
6649
6650 Available values are 0, 2 and 3.
6651 If 'pyxversion' is 0, it is set to 2 or 3 after the first execution of
6652 any python2/3 commands or functions. E.g. `:py` sets to 2, and `:py3`
6653 sets to 3. `:pyx` sets it to 3 if Python 3 is available, otherwise sets
6654 to 2 if Python 2 is available.
6655 See also: |has-pythonx|
6656
6657 If Vim is compiled with only |+python| or |+python3| setting
6658 'pyxversion' has no effect. The pyx* functions and commands are
6659 always the same as the compiled version.
6660
6661 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6662 security reasons.
6663
Bram Moolenaar858ba062020-05-31 23:11:59 +02006664 *'quickfixtextfunc'* *'qftf'*
6665'quickfixtextfunc' 'qftf' string (default "")
6666 global
6667 {only available when compiled with the |+quickfix|
6668 feature}
6669 This option specifies a function to be used to get the text to display
6670 in the quickfix and location list windows. This can be used to
6671 customize the information displayed in the quickfix or location window
6672 for each entry in the corresponding quickfix or location list. See
6673 |quickfix-window-function| for an explanation of how to write the
Yegappan Lakshmanan777175b2021-11-18 22:08:57 +00006674 function and an example. The value can be the name of a function, a
6675 |lambda| or a |Funcref|. See |option-value-function| for more
6676 information.
Bram Moolenaar858ba062020-05-31 23:11:59 +02006677
6678 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6679 security reasons.
6680
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00006681 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'*
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00006682'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\")
6683 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00006684 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for
6685 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|.
6686 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string,
6687 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the
6688 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string.
6689
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006690 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'*
6691'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off)
Christian Brabandt596ad662023-08-16 00:11:09 +02006692 local to buffer |local-noglobal|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006693 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from
6694 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started
6695 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view".
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00006696 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current
6697 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02006698 When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is set for the
6699 newly edited buffer.
Bram Moolenaar369b6f52017-01-17 12:22:32 +01006700 See 'modifiable' for disallowing changes to the buffer.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006701
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006702 *'redrawtime'* *'rdt'*
6703'redrawtime' 'rdt' number (default 2000)
6704 global
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006705 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime|
6706 feature}
6707 The time in milliseconds for redrawing the display. This applies to
Bram Moolenaar15142e22018-04-30 22:19:58 +02006708 searching for patterns for 'hlsearch', |:match| highlighting and syntax
Bram Moolenaar06f1ed22017-06-18 22:41:03 +02006709 highlighting.
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006710 When redrawing takes more than this many milliseconds no further
Bram Moolenaar06f1ed22017-06-18 22:41:03 +02006711 matches will be highlighted.
6712 For syntax highlighting the time applies per window. When over the
6713 limit syntax highlighting is disabled until |CTRL-L| is used.
6714 This is used to avoid that Vim hangs when using a very complicated
6715 pattern.
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006716
Bram Moolenaar543b7ef2013-06-01 14:50:56 +02006717 *'regexpengine'* *'re'*
Bram Moolenaare6ae6222013-05-21 21:01:10 +02006718'regexpengine' 're' number (default 0)
6719 global
Bram Moolenaare6ae6222013-05-21 21:01:10 +02006720 This selects the default regexp engine. |two-engines|
6721 The possible values are:
6722 0 automatic selection
6723 1 old engine
6724 2 NFA engine
6725 Note that when using the NFA engine and the pattern contains something
6726 that is not supported the pattern will not match. This is only useful
6727 for debugging the regexp engine.
Bram Moolenaarfda37292014-11-05 14:27:36 +01006728 Using automatic selection enables Vim to switch the engine, if the
6729 default engine becomes too costly. E.g., when the NFA engine uses too
6730 many states. This should prevent Vim from hanging on a combination of
6731 a complex pattern with long text.
Bram Moolenaare6ae6222013-05-21 21:01:10 +02006732
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006733 *'relativenumber'* *'rnu'* *'norelativenumber'* *'nornu'*
6734'relativenumber' 'rnu' boolean (default off)
6735 local to window
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006736 Show the line number relative to the line with the cursor in front of
Bram Moolenaar06b5d512010-05-22 15:37:44 +02006737 each line. Relative line numbers help you use the |count| you can
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006738 precede some vertical motion commands (e.g. j k + -) with, without
6739 having to calculate it yourself. Especially useful in combination with
6740 other commands (e.g. y d c < > gq gw =).
6741 When the 'n' option is excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped
6742 line will not use the column of line numbers (this is the default when
6743 'compatible' isn't set).
6744 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
6745 number.
6746 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
6747 characters are put before the number.
Bram Moolenaar61d35bd2012-03-28 20:51:51 +02006748 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for
6749 the number.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01006750
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02006751 The number in front of the cursor line also depends on the value of
6752 'number', see |number_relativenumber| for all combinations of the two
6753 options.
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006754
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006755 *'remap'* *'noremap'*
6756'remap' boolean (default on)
6757 global
6758 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for
6759 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command.
Bram Moolenaara3227e22006-03-08 21:32:40 +00006760 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with Vim scripts, always keep
6761 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
6762 old Vi scripts.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006763
zeertzjqd086b8f2024-02-25 15:42:52 +08006764 *'renderoptions'* *'rop'*
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006765'renderoptions' 'rop' string (default: empty)
6766 global
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006767 {only available when compiled with GUI and DIRECTX on
6768 MS-Windows}
6769 Select a text renderer and set its options. The options depend on the
6770 renderer.
6771
6772 Syntax: >
6773 set rop=type:{renderer}(,{name}:{value})*
6774<
6775 Currently, only one optional renderer is available.
6776
6777 render behavior ~
6778 directx Vim will draw text using DirectX (DirectWrite). It makes
6779 drawn glyphs more beautiful than default GDI.
6780 It requires 'encoding' is "utf-8", and only works on
6781 MS-Windows Vista or newer version.
6782
6783 Options:
6784 name meaning type value ~
6785 gamma gamma float 1.0 - 2.2 (maybe)
6786 contrast enhancedContrast float (unknown)
6787 level clearTypeLevel float (unknown)
6788 geom pixelGeometry int 0 - 2 (see below)
6789 renmode renderingMode int 0 - 6 (see below)
6790 taamode textAntialiasMode int 0 - 3 (see below)
Bram Moolenaara338adc2018-01-31 20:51:47 +01006791 scrlines Scroll Lines int (deprecated)
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006792
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006793 See this URL for detail (except for scrlines):
6794 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368190.aspx
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006795
6796 For geom: structure of a device pixel.
6797 0 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_FLAT
6798 1 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_RGB
6799 2 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_BGR
6800
6801 See this URL for detail:
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006802 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368114.aspx
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006803
6804 For renmode: method of rendering glyphs.
6805 0 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_DEFAULT
6806 1 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_ALIASED
6807 2 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_CLASSIC
6808 3 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_NATURAL
6809 4 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL
6810 5 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL_SYMMETRIC
6811 6 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_OUTLINE
6812
6813 See this URL for detail:
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006814 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368118.aspx
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006815
6816 For taamode: antialiasing mode used for drawing text.
6817 0 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_DEFAULT
6818 1 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_CLEARTYPE
6819 2 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_GRAYSCALE
6820 3 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_ALIASED
6821
6822 See this URL for detail:
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006823 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368170.aspx
6824
Bram Moolenaara338adc2018-01-31 20:51:47 +01006825 For scrlines:
6826 This was used for optimizing scrolling behavior, however this
6827 is now deprecated. If specified, it is simply ignored.
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006828
6829 Example: >
6830 set encoding=utf-8
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006831 set gfn=Ricty_Diminished:h12
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006832 set rop=type:directx
6833<
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006834 If select a raster font (Courier, Terminal or FixedSys which
6835 have ".fon" extension in file name) to 'guifont', it will be
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006836 drawn by GDI as a fallback.
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006837
6838 NOTE: It is known that some fonts and options combination
6839 causes trouble on drawing glyphs.
6840
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006841 - 'renmode:5' and 'renmode:6' will not work with some
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006842 special made fonts (True-Type fonts which includes only
6843 bitmap glyphs).
6844 - 'taamode:3' will not work with some vector fonts.
6845
6846 NOTE: With this option, you can display colored emoji
6847 (emoticon) in Windows 8.1 or later. To display colored emoji,
6848 there are some conditions which you should notice.
6849
6850 - If your font includes non-colored emoji already, it will
6851 be used.
6852 - If your font doesn't have emoji, the system chooses an
6853 alternative symbol font. On Windows 10, "Segoe UI Emoji"
6854 will be used.
6855 - When this alternative font didn't have fixed width glyph,
6856 emoji might be rendered beyond the bounding box of drawing
6857 cell.
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006858
6859 Other render types are currently not supported.
6860
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006861 *'report'*
6862'report' number (default 2)
6863 global
6864 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of
6865 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most
6866 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0.
6867 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used
6868 instead of the number of lines.
6869
6870 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'*
6871'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on)
6872 global
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01006873 {only in MS-Windows console version}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006874 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also
6875 happens when executing external commands.
6876
6877 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te'
6878 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring:
6879 set t_ti= t_te=
6880 To enable restoring (for an xterm):
6881 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8
6882 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it)
6883
6884 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'*
6885'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off)
6886 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006887 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
6888 feature}
6889 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing
6890 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_
6891 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006892 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6893 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
6894 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006895
6896 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'*
6897'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off)
6898 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006899 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
6900 feature}
6901 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters
6902 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left.
6903 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that
6904 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic.
6905 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files
6906 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is
6907 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left
6908 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly
6909 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|.
6910
Bram Moolenaar607cc1e2010-07-18 18:47:44 +02006911 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006912'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search")
6913 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006914 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
6915 feature}
6916 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in
6917 right-to-left mode for a group of commands:
6918
6919 search "/" and "?" commands
6920
6921 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi.
6922 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect.
6923
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006924 *'rubydll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01006925'rubydll' string (default: depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006926 global
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006927 {only available when compiled with the |+ruby/dyn|
6928 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006929 Specifies the name of the Ruby shared library. The default is
6930 DYNAMIC_RUBY_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02006931 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006932 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6933 security reasons.
6934
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006935 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02006936'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006937 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006938 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006939 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006940 text in the file is shown on the far right:
6941 Top first line is visible
6942 Bot last line is visible
6943 All first and last line are visible
6944 45% relative position in the file
6945 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006946 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the
Bram Moolenaara2a89732022-08-31 14:46:18 +01006947 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the
6948 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty),
6949 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006950 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of
Bram Moolenaar207f0092020-08-30 17:20:20 +02006951 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multibyte character), both
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006952 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown,
6953 separated with a dash.
6954 For an empty line "0-1" is shown.
6955 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1".
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006956 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
6957 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006958 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where
6959 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|.
6960 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6961
6962 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'*
6963'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty)
6964 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006965 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
6966 feature}
6967 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler
6968 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00006969 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02006970 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
6971
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006972 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15
6973 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end.
6974 Example: >
6975 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%)
6976<
6977 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles*
6978'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default:
Christian Brabandtc3e6e392024-05-04 09:48:15 +02006979 Unix: "$HOME/.vim or
6980 $XDG_CONFIG_HOME/vim,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006981 $VIM/vimfiles,
6982 $VIMRUNTIME,
6983 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6984 $HOME/.vim/after"
6985 Amiga: "home:vimfiles,
6986 $VIM/vimfiles,
6987 $VIMRUNTIME,
6988 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6989 home:vimfiles/after"
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01006990 MS-Windows: "$HOME/vimfiles,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006991 $VIM/vimfiles,
6992 $VIMRUNTIME,
6993 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6994 $HOME/vimfiles/after"
Bram Moolenaarb3f74062020-02-26 16:16:53 +01006995 Haiku: "$BE_USER_SETTINGS/vim,
6996 $VIM/vimfiles,
6997 $VIMRUNTIME,
6998 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01006999 $BE_USER_SETTINGS/vim/after"
7000 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007001 $VIM/vimfiles,
7002 $VIMRUNTIME,
7003 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007004 sys$login:vimfiles/after")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007005 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007006 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime
7007 files:
7008 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype|
7009 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts|
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00007010 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007011 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme|
7012 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler|
7013 doc/ documentation |write-local-help|
7014 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin|
Bram Moolenaar8a7d6542020-01-26 15:56:19 +01007015 import/ files that are found by `:import`
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007016 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression|
7017 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap|
RestorerZ96509102024-07-11 21:14:15 +02007018 lang/ message translations |:menutrans| and |multi-lang|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007019 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim|
Bram Moolenaar26852122016-05-24 20:02:38 +02007020 pack/ packages |:packadd|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007021 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin|
7022 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding|
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00007023 spell/ spell checking files |spell|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007024 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile|
7025 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor|
7026
7027 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command.
7028
Christian Brabandtc3e6e392024-05-04 09:48:15 +02007029 For $XDG_CONFIG_HOME see |xdg-base-dir|.
7030
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007031 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations:
7032 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences.
7033 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system
7034 administrator.
7035 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim.
7036 *after-directory*
7037 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is
7038 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed
7039 defaults (rarely needed)
7040 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for
7041 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults
7042 or system-wide settings (rarely needed).
7043
Bram Moolenaard0796902016-09-16 20:02:31 +02007044 More entries are added when using |packages|. If it gets very long
7045 then `:set rtp` will be truncated, use `:echo &rtp` to see the full
7046 string.
Bram Moolenaar26852122016-05-24 20:02:38 +02007047
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007048 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal
7049 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007050 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007051 wildcards.
7052 See |:runtime|.
7053 Example: >
7054 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME
7055< This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your
7056 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a
7057 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime
7058 files).
7059 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the
7060 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME
7061 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put
7062 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed
7063 runtime files.
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01007064 When Vim is started with |--clean| the home directory entries are not
7065 included.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007066 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7067 security reasons.
7068
7069 *'scroll'* *'scr'*
7070'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height)
Christian Brabandt596ad662023-08-16 00:11:09 +02007071 local to window |local-noglobal|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007072 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be
7073 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size
Bram Moolenaar74667062020-12-28 15:41:41 +01007074 changes. This may happen when enabling the |status-line| or
7075 'tabline' option after setting the 'scroll' option.
7076 If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007077 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window
Bram Moolenaar25c9c682019-05-05 18:13:34 +02007078 height with ":set scroll=0".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007079
7080 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'*
7081'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off)
7082 local to window
zeertzjq5277cfa2023-09-28 01:00:12 +08007083 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, scrolling the
7084 current window also scrolls other scrollbind windows (windows that
7085 also have this option set). This option is useful for viewing the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007086 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'.
7087 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be
7088 interpreted.
7089 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another
7090 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows
7091 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not.
7092
Bram Moolenaarae20f342019-11-05 21:09:23 +01007093 *'scrollfocus'* *'scf'* *'noscrollfocus'* *'noscf'*
7094'scrollfocus' 'scf' boolean (default off)
7095 global
7096 {only for MS-Windows GUI}
7097 When using the scroll wheel and this option is set, the window under
7098 the mouse pointer is scrolled. With this option off the current
7099 window is scrolled.
Bram Moolenaar5ef1c6a2019-11-10 22:09:11 +01007100 Systems other than MS-Windows always behave like this option is on.
Bram Moolenaarae20f342019-11-05 21:09:23 +01007101
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007102 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'*
7103'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1)
7104 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007105 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the
7106 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E,
7107 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly.
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00007108 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the
7109 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window
7110 height.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007111 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set.
7112
7113 *'scrolloff'* *'so'*
Bram Moolenaar50ba5262016-09-22 22:33:02 +02007114'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0, set to 5 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar375e3392019-01-31 18:26:10 +01007115 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007116 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor.
7117 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If
7118 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be
7119 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or
7120 when long lines wrap).
Bram Moolenaar375e3392019-01-31 18:26:10 +01007121 After using the local value, go back the global value with one of
7122 these two: >
7123 setlocal scrolloff<
7124 setlocal scrolloff=-1
7125< For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007126 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
7127
7128 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'*
7129'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump")
7130 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007131 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00007132 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind
7133 Options.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007134 The following words are available:
7135 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
7136 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
7137 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical
7138 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first
7139 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving
7140 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may
7141 reach a position before the start or after the end of
7142 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when
7143 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll
7144 to the desired position when possible.
7145 When now making that window the current one, two
7146 things can be done with the relative offset:
7147 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is
7148 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current
7149 window. When going back to the other window, the
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00007150 new relative offset will be used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007151 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are
7152 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When
7153 going back to the other window, it still uses the
7154 same relative offset.
7155 Also see |scroll-binding|.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00007156 When 'diff' mode is active there always is vertical scroll binding,
7157 even when "ver" isn't there.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007158
7159 *'sections'* *'sect'*
7160'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh")
7161 global
7162 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of
7163 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start
7164 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh".
7165
7166 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523*
7167'secure' boolean (default off)
7168 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007169 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in
7170 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are
7171 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into
7172 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is
7173 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007174 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007175 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then.
7176 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7177 security reasons.
7178
7179 *'selection'* *'sel'*
7180'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive")
7181 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007182 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used
7183 in Visual and Select mode.
7184 Possible values:
7185 value past line inclusive ~
7186 old no yes
7187 inclusive yes yes
7188 exclusive yes no
7189 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one
7190 character past the line.
7191 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included
7192 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the
7193 selection.
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02007194 When "old" is used and 'virtualedit' allows the cursor to move past
7195 the end of line the line break still isn't included.
Christian Brabandted892062024-12-14 20:23:39 +01007196 When "exclusive" is used, cursor position in visual mode will be
7197 adjusted for inclusive motions |inclusive-motion-selection-exclusive|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007198 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end
7199 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when
7200 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty.
7201
7202 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command.
7203
7204 *'selectmode'* *'slm'*
7205'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "")
7206 global
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01007207 This is a comma-separated list of words, which specifies when to start
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007208 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started.
7209 Possible values:
7210 mouse when using the mouse
7211 key when using shifted special keys
7212 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V
7213 See |Select-mode|.
7214 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command.
7215
7216 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'*
7217'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds,
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01007218 help,options,tabpages,winsize,terminal")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007219 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02007220 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007221 feature}
7222 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma
7223 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring
7224 something:
7225 word save and restore ~
7226 blank empty windows
7227 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows
7228 curdir the current directory
7229 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
7230 fold options
7231 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00007232 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only
7233 String and Number types are stored.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007234 help the help window
7235 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
7236 global values for local options)
7237 options all options and mappings (also global values for local
7238 options)
Bram Moolenaard23b7142021-04-17 21:04:34 +02007239 skiprtp exclude 'runtimepath' and 'packpath' from the options
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007240 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns'
7241 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located
7242 will become the current directory (useful with
7243 projects accessed over a network from different
7244 systems)
7245 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
7246 slashes
Bram Moolenaar18144c82006-04-12 21:52:12 +00007247 tabpages all tab pages; without this only the current tab page
7248 is restored, so that you can make a session for each
7249 tab page separately
Bram Moolenaard473c8c2018-08-11 18:00:22 +02007250 terminal include terminal windows where the command can be
7251 restored
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007252 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
7253 on Windows or DOS
7254 winpos position of the whole Vim window
7255 winsize window sizes
7256
7257 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir".
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01007258 When neither "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored
7259 with absolute paths.
Bram Moolenaar2f0936c2022-01-08 21:51:59 +00007260 If you leave out "options" many things won't work well after restoring
7261 the session.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007262 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files
7263 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
7264 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
7265
7266 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91*
Bram Moolenaar95a9dd12019-12-19 22:12:03 +01007267'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh", Win32: "cmd.exe")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007268 global
7269 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the
7270 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash'
7271 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007272 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007273 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
7274 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01007275
Bram Moolenaara2baa732022-02-04 16:09:54 +00007276 In |restricted-mode| shell commands will not be possible. This mode
7277 is used if the value of $SHELL ends in "false" or "nologin".
7278
Bram Moolenaar1ff14ba2019-11-02 14:09:23 +01007279 If the name of the shell contains a space, you need to enclose it in
Bram Moolenaar5ef1c6a2019-11-10 22:09:11 +01007280 quotes and escape the space. Example with quotes: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007281 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f
7282< Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007283 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007284 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01007285 name. Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007286 separators.
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01007287 Example with escaped space (Vim will do this when initializing the
7288 option from $SHELL): >
7289 :set shell=/bin/with\\\ space/sh
Bram Moolenaard473c8c2018-08-11 18:00:22 +02007290< The resulting value of 'shell' is "/bin/with\ space/sh", two
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01007291 backslashes are consumed by `:set`.
7292
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007293 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be
7294 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com"
7295 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g.,
7296 filtering).
7297 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is
7298 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: >
7299 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos
7300< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7301 security reasons.
7302
7303 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'*
Bram Moolenaar5dc62522012-02-13 00:05:22 +01007304'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c";
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02007305 Win32, when 'shell' contains "powershell":
7306 "-Command", or when it does not contain "sh"
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01007307 somewhere: "/c")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007308 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007309 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g.,
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02007310 "bash.exe -c ls", "powershell.exe -Command dir", or "cmd.exe /c dir".
7311 For MS-Windows, the default is set according to the value of 'shell',
7312 to reduce the need to set this option by the user.
Bram Moolenaar5302d9e2011-09-14 17:55:08 +02007313 On Unix it can have more than one flag. Each white space separated
7314 part is passed as an argument to the shell command.
7315 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02007316 Also see |dos-shell| and |dos-powershell| for MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007317 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7318 security reasons.
7319
7320 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'*
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02007321'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", ">%s 2>&1", "| tee", "|& tee"
7322 "2>&1| tee", or
7323 "2>&1 | Out-File -Encoding default")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007324 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007325 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
7326 feature}
7327 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007328 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007329 including spaces and backslashes.
7330 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
7331 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
7332 of this option).
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02007333 For the Amiga the default is ">". For MS-Windows using powershell the
7334 default is "2>&1 | Out-File -Encoding default", otherwise the default
7335 is ">%s 2>&1". The output is directly saved in a file and not echoed
7336 to the screen.
Bram Moolenaar1c6737b2020-09-07 22:18:52 +02007337 For Unix the default is "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007338 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or
7339 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the
Bram Moolenaar96f45c02019-10-26 19:53:45 +02007340 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh", "zsh-beta",
Natanael Copa56318362021-05-06 18:46:35 +02007341 "bash", "fish", "ash" or "dash" the default becomes "2>&1| tee". This
7342 means that stderr is also included. Before using the 'shell' option a
7343 path is removed, thus "/bin/sh" uses "sh".
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02007344 For Unix and MS-Windows, when the 'shell' option is "pwsh" the default
7345 becomes ">%s 2>&1" and the output is not echoed to the screen.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007346 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
7347 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
7348 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was
7349 explicitly set before.
7350 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the
7351 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg'
7352 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do
7353 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space.
7354 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ".
7355 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
7356 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
7357 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7358 security reasons.
7359
7360 *'shellquote'* *'shq'*
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02007361'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: "")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007362 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007363 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
7364 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the
7365 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's
7366 probably not useful to set both options.
7367 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01007368 third-party shells on MS-Windows-like systems, such as the MKS Korn
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02007369 Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". See |dos-shell|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007370 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7371 security reasons.
7372
7373 *'shellredir'* *'srr'*
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02007374'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&", ">%s 2>&1", or
7375 "2>&1 | Out-File -Encoding default")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007376 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007377 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary
7378 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces
7379 and backslashes.
7380 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
7381 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
7382 of this option).
Bram Moolenaar96f45c02019-10-26 19:53:45 +02007383 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh" or
7384 "tcsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01007385 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh", "zsh-beta",
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02007386 "bash", "fish", or "pwsh", the default becomes ">%s 2>&1". This means
7387 that stderr is also included. For Win32, the Unix checks are done and
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02007388 additionally "cmd" is checked for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1",
7389 and "powershell" is checked for which makes the default
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02007390 "2>&1 | Out-File -Encoding default" (see |dos-powershell|). Also, the
7391 same names with ".exe" appended are checked for.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007392 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
7393 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
7394 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was
7395 explicitly set before.
7396 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
7397 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
7398 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7399 security reasons.
7400
7401 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'*
7402'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off)
7403 global
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01007404 {only for MS-Windows}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007405 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02007406 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of cmd.exe, pwsh.exe, or
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02007407 powershell.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are
7408 changed to forward slashes by Vim.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007409 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some
7410 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening
7411 any file for best results. This might change in the future.
7412 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path
7413 separator. To test if this is so use: >
7414 if exists('+shellslash')
Bram Moolenaarac3150d2019-07-28 16:36:39 +02007415< Also see 'completeslash'.
7416
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00007417 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'*
7418'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on)
7419 global
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00007420 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe.
7421 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway.
Bram Moolenaar97293012011-07-18 19:40:27 +02007422 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix and MS-Windows 2K and
7423 later. You can check it with: >
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00007424 :if has("filterpipe")
7425< The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file
7426 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection.
7427 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding
7428 can be detected.
7429 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|,
7430 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when
7431 'shelltemp' is off.
Bram Moolenaar269f5952016-07-15 22:54:41 +02007432 The `system()` function does not respect this option and always uses
7433 temp files.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01007434 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
7435 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00007436
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007437 *'shelltype'* *'st'*
7438'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0)
7439 global
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02007440 {only for the Amiga}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007441 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work
7442 which use a shell.
7443 0 and 1: always use the shell
7444 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines
7445 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command
7446 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly.
7447
7448 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands
7449 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands
7450
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01007451 *'shellxescape'* *'sxe'*
7452'shellxescape' 'sxe' string (default: "";
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01007453 for MS-Windows: "\"&|<>()@^")
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01007454 global
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01007455 When 'shellxquote' is set to "(" then the characters listed in this
7456 option will be escaped with a '^' character. This makes it possible
7457 to execute most external commands with cmd.exe.
dkearns8ebdbc92023-10-29 06:26:19 +11007458 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7459 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01007460
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007461 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'*
7462'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: "";
Bram Moolenaarf66b3fc2012-02-20 22:18:30 +01007463 for Win32, when 'shell' is cmd.exe: "("
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02007464 for Win32, when 'shell' is
7465 powershell.exe: "\""
Bram Moolenaarf66b3fc2012-02-20 22:18:30 +01007466 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh"
7467 somewhere: "\""
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007468 for Unix, when using system(): "\"")
7469 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007470 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
7471 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See
7472 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful
7473 to set both options.
Bram Moolenaarf66b3fc2012-02-20 22:18:30 +01007474 When the value is '(' then ')' is appended. When the value is '"('
7475 then ')"' is appended.
7476 When the value is '(' then also see 'shellxescape'.
Bram Moolenaara64ba222012-02-12 23:23:31 +01007477 This is an empty string by default on most systems, but is known to be
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02007478 useful for on Win32 version, either for cmd.exe, powershell.exe, or
7479 pwsh.exe which automatically strips off the first and last quote on a
7480 command, or 3rd-party shells such as the MKS Korn Shell or bash, where
7481 it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according the value of
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02007482 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the user. See
7483 |dos-shell|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007484 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7485 security reasons.
7486
7487 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'*
7488'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off)
7489 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007490 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and <
7491 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to
7492 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible).
7493 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
7494
7495 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'*
7496'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8)
7497 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007498 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007499 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc.
Bram Moolenaar10e8ff92023-06-10 21:40:39 +01007500 When zero the 'tabstop' value will be used. Use the |shiftwidth()|
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +02007501 function to get the effective shiftwidth value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007502
7503 *'shortmess'* *'shm'*
Bram Moolenaar9dfa3132019-05-04 21:08:40 +02007504'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToOS", Vi default: "S",
7505 POSIX default: "AS")
Bram Moolenaarf1dcd142022-12-31 15:30:45 +00007506 global *E1336*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007507 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file
Dominique Pellédf62c622024-07-15 20:29:59 +02007508 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007509 It is a list of flags:
7510 flag meaning when present ~
Bram Moolenaar7db29e42022-12-11 15:53:04 +00007511 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)" *shm-f*
7512 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]" *shm-i*
7513 l use "999L, 888B" instead of "999 lines, 888 bytes" *shm-l*
7514 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]" *shm-m*
7515 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]" *shm-n*
7516 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]" *shm-r*
7517 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message *shm-w*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007518 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command
Bram Moolenaar7db29e42022-12-11 15:53:04 +00007519 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" *shm-x*
7520 instead of "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac
Bram Moolenaarf1dcd142022-12-31 15:30:45 +00007521 format]"
Bram Moolenaar7db29e42022-12-11 15:53:04 +00007522 a all of the above abbreviations *shm-a*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007523
Bram Moolenaar7db29e42022-12-11 15:53:04 +00007524 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent *shm-o*
7525 message for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when
7526 'autowrite' on)
Bram Moolenaarf1dcd142022-12-31 15:30:45 +00007527 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous *shm-O*
7528 message; also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn")
Bram Moolenaar7db29e42022-12-11 15:53:04 +00007529 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or *shm-s*
7530 "search hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages; when using
Christian Brabandte2995912024-06-01 20:40:25 +02007531 the search count do not show "W" before the count message
7532 (see |shm-S| below)
Bram Moolenaar7db29e42022-12-11 15:53:04 +00007533 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long *shm-t*
7534 to fit on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most
Bram Moolenaarf1dcd142022-12-31 15:30:45 +00007535 column; ignored in Ex mode
Bram Moolenaar7db29e42022-12-11 15:53:04 +00007536 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too *shm-T*
Bram Moolenaarf1dcd142022-12-31 15:30:45 +00007537 long to fit on the command line; "..." will appear in the
7538 middle; ignored in Ex mode
Bram Moolenaar7db29e42022-12-11 15:53:04 +00007539 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file *shm-W*
7540 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing *shm-A*
Bram Moolenaarf1dcd142022-12-31 15:30:45 +00007541 swap file is found
Bram Moolenaar7db29e42022-12-11 15:53:04 +00007542 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim, *shm-I*
Bram Moolenaar938ae282023-02-20 20:44:55 +00007543 see |:intro|
Bram Moolenaarf1dcd142022-12-31 15:30:45 +00007544 c don't give |ins-completion-menu| messages; for *shm-c*
Bram Moolenaar7db29e42022-12-11 15:53:04 +00007545 example, "-- XXX completion (YYY)", "match 1 of 2", "The only
7546 match", "Pattern not found", "Back at original", etc.
7547 C don't give messages while scanning for ins-completion *shm-C*
7548 items, for instance "scanning tags"
7549 q use "recording" instead of "recording @a" *shm-q*
7550 F don't give the file info when editing a file, like *shm-F*
7551 `:silent` was used for the command; note that this also
Shougo Matsushita9db39b02024-03-06 20:58:41 +01007552 affects messages from autocommands and 'autoread' reloading
Bram Moolenaar938ae282023-02-20 20:44:55 +00007553 S do not show search count message when searching, e.g. *shm-S*
Christian Brabandte2995912024-06-01 20:40:25 +02007554 "[1/5]". When the "S" flag is not present (e.g. search count
7555 is shown), the "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" and
7556 "search hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages are only
7557 indicated by a "W" (Mnemonic: Wrapped) letter before the
7558 search count statistics.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007559
7560 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers
7561 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as
7562 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you
7563 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!"
7564 Useful values:
7565 shm= No abbreviation of message.
7566 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information.
7567 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary.
7568
7569 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7570 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7571
7572 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'*
7573'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off)
7574 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007575 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3
7576 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this
7577 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01007578 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is useful
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007579 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos
Bram Moolenaarade0d392020-01-21 22:33:58 +01007580 or crossdos.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007581
7582 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595*
7583'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaaree857022019-11-09 23:26:40 +01007584 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02007585 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007586 feature}
7587 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01007588 values are "> " or "+++ ": >
7589 :set showbreak=>\
7590< Note the backslash to escape the trailing space. It's easier like
7591 this: >
Bram Moolenaar1a384422010-07-14 19:53:30 +02007592 :let &showbreak = '+++ '
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01007593< Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007594 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the
7595 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line).
7596 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in
7597 'highlight'.
7598 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently.
7599 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the
7600 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaaree857022019-11-09 23:26:40 +01007601 A window-local value overrules a global value. If the global value is
7602 set and you want no value in the current window use NONE: >
7603 :setlocal showbreak=NONE
7604<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007605 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02007606'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix,
7607 Vi default: off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007608 global
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00007609 Show (partial) command in the last line of the screen. Set this
7610 option off if your terminal is slow.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007611 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown:
7612 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters.
Bram Moolenaarf91787c2010-07-17 12:47:16 +02007613 If the number of bytes is different it is also displayed: "2-6"
7614 means two characters and six bytes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007615 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01007616 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters:
7617 {lines}x{columns}.
Luuk van Baalba936f62022-12-15 13:15:39 +00007618 This information can be displayed in an alternative location using the
7619 'showcmdloc' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007620 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7621 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7622
Luuk van Baalba936f62022-12-15 13:15:39 +00007623 *'showcmdloc'* *'sloc'*
7624'showcmdloc' 'sloc' string (default "last")
Bram Moolenaarf1dcd142022-12-31 15:30:45 +00007625 global
Luuk van Baalba936f62022-12-15 13:15:39 +00007626 This option can be used to display the (partially) entered command in
7627 another location. Possible values are:
7628 last Last line of the screen (default).
7629 statusline Status line of the current window.
Bram Moolenaarf1dcd142022-12-31 15:30:45 +00007630 tabline First line of the screen if 'showtabline' is enabled.
Luuk van Baalba936f62022-12-15 13:15:39 +00007631 Setting this option to "statusline" or "tabline" means that these will
7632 be redrawn whenever the command changes, which can be on every key
7633 pressed.
7634 The %S 'statusline' item can be used in 'statusline' or 'tabline' to
7635 place the text. Without a custom 'statusline' or 'tabline' it will be
7636 displayed in a convenient location.
7637
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007638 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'*
7639'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off)
7640 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007641 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the
7642 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007643 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007644 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are
7645 required (coding style permitting).
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007646 Note that this doesn't work well together with having "longest" in
7647 'completeopt', because the completion from the search pattern may not
7648 match the typed text.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007649
7650 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'*
7651'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off)
7652 global
7653 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The
7654 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to
7655 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'.
7656 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007657 seen or not).
7658 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
7659 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007660 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character
7661 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs.
7662 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and
7663 blinking when showing the match.
7664 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show
7665 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite
7666 matches.
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007667 Also see the matchparen plugin for highlighting the match when moving
7668 around |pi_paren.txt|.
7669 Note: Use of the short form is rated PG.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007670
7671 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'*
7672'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
7673 global
7674 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line.
7675 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for
7676 this message.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007677 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007678 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is
7679 not set.
7680 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7681 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7682
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007683 *'showtabline'* *'stal'*
7684'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1)
7685 global
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007686 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels
7687 will be displayed:
7688 0: never
7689 1: only if there are at least two tab pages
7690 2: always
7691 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages
7692 line.
7693 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages.
7694
Naruhiko Nishinobe5bd4d2025-05-14 21:20:28 +02007695 *'showtabpanel'* *'stpl'*
7696'showtabpanel' 'stpl' number (default 0)
7697 global
7698 {not in Vi}
7699 {not available when compiled without the |+tabpanel|
7700 feature}
7701 The value of this option specifies when the |tabpanel| with tab page
7702 labels will be displayed:
7703 0: never
7704 1: only if there are at least two tab pages
7705 2: always
7706 This is for the non-GUI implementation of the tabpanel only.
7707 See |tab-page| for more information about tab page labels.
7708
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007709 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'*
7710'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0)
7711 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007712 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when
7713 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen.
7714 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen.
7715 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using
7716 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl"
7717 commands.
7718
7719 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'*
7720'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0)
Bram Moolenaar375e3392019-01-31 18:26:10 +01007721 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007722 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00007723 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a
7724 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero
7725 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in
7726 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option
7727 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor
7728 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too
7729 close to the beginning of the line.
Bram Moolenaar375e3392019-01-31 18:26:10 +01007730 After using the local value, go back the global value with one of
7731 these two: >
7732 setlocal sidescrolloff<
7733 setlocal sidescrolloff=-1
7734< NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007735
7736 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as
7737 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +02007738 onto the "extends" character: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007739
7740 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:<
7741 :set sidescrolloff=1
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +02007742<
7743 *'signcolumn'* *'scl'*
7744'signcolumn' 'scl' string (default "auto")
7745 local to window
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +02007746 {not available when compiled without the |+signs|
7747 feature}
Bram Moolenaar09521312016-08-12 22:54:35 +02007748 Whether or not to draw the signcolumn. Valid values are:
Bram Moolenaar938ae282023-02-20 20:44:55 +00007749 "auto" only when there is a sign to display
7750 "no" never
7751 "yes" always
Bram Moolenaar394c5d82019-06-17 21:48:05 +02007752 "number" display signs in the 'number' column. If the number
Bram Moolenaar6c1e1572019-06-22 02:13:00 +02007753 column is not present, then behaves like "auto".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007754
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007755 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'*
7756'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off)
7757 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007758 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper
7759 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and
7760 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N",
Girish Palyadc314052025-05-08 23:28:52 +02007761 ":g" and ":s" and when filtering matches for the completion menu
7762 |compl-states|.
7763 Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc. After "*" and "#" you
7764 can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command, recalling the search
7765 pattern from history and hitting <Enter>.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007766 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
7767
7768 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'*
7769'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off)
7770 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007771 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like
7772 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does
7773 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict,
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01007774 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on or 'indentexpr' is set,
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01007775 setting 'si' has no effect. 'indentexpr' is a more advanced
7776 alternative.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007777 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'.
7778 An indent is automatically inserted:
7779 - After a line ending in '{'.
7780 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'.
7781 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command).
7782 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is
7783 given the same indent as the matching '{'.
7784 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for
7785 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007786 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007787 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H.
7788 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted
7789 right.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01007790 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007791 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
7792 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007793
7794 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'*
7795'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off)
7796 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007797 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00007798 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A
7799 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the
7800 line.
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00007801 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00007802 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or
7803 right |shift-left-right|.
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00007804 What gets inserted (a <Tab> or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007805 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00007806 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007807 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
7808 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007809 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
7810
Bram Moolenaarf6196f42022-10-02 21:29:55 +01007811 *'smoothscroll'* *'sms'* *'nosmoothscroll'* *'nosms'*
7812'smoothscroll' 'sms' boolean (default off)
7813 local to window
7814 Scrolling works with screen lines. When 'wrap' is set and the first
7815 line in the window wraps part of it may not be visible, as if it is
Bram Moolenaarf269eab2022-10-03 18:04:35 +01007816 above the window. "<<<" is displayed at the start of the first line,
7817 highlighted with |hl-NonText|.
Bram Moolenaar10e8ff92023-06-10 21:40:39 +01007818 You may also want to add "lastline" to the 'display' option to show as
7819 much of the last line as possible.
zeertzjqad493ef2024-03-29 10:23:19 +01007820 NOTE: partly implemented, doesn't work yet for |gj| and |gk|.
Bram Moolenaarf6196f42022-10-02 21:29:55 +01007821
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007822 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'*
7823'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0)
7824 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007825 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing
7826 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like
7827 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is
7828 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value
7829 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However,
7830 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters.
7831 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off.
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +02007832 When 'sts' is negative, the value of 'shiftwidth' is used.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007833 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored
7834 when 'paste' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007835 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of
7836 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
7837 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is
7838 set.
7839 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
7840
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02007841 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of
7842 'softtabstop' will be ignored if |'varsofttabstop'| is set to
7843 anything other than an empty string.
7844
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007845 *'spell'* *'nospell'*
7846'spell' boolean (default off)
7847 local to window
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007848 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7849 feature}
7850 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00007851 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'.
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007852
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007853 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'*
Bram Moolenaar0dc065e2005-07-04 22:49:24 +00007854'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+")
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007855 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007856 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7857 feature}
7858 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be
7859 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00007860 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled).
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007861 When this check is not wanted make this option empty.
7862 Only used when 'spell' is set.
Bram Moolenaar0dc065e2005-07-04 22:49:24 +00007863 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about
7864 including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007865 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see
7866 |set-spc-auto|.
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007867
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007868 *'spellfile'* *'spf'*
7869'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty)
7870 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007871 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7872 feature}
7873 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw|
Bram Moolenaar045e82d2005-07-08 22:25:33 +00007874 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the
7875 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory.
Bram Moolenaar48c3f4e2022-08-08 15:42:38 +01007876 The path may include characters from 'isfname', space, comma and '@'.
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007877 *E765*
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01007878 It may also be a comma-separated list of names. A count before the
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007879 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using
7880 a personal word list file and a project word list file.
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007881 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00007882 you: Using the first directory in 'runtimepath' that is writable. If
7883 there is no "spell" directory yet it will be created. For the file
7884 name the first language name that appears in 'spelllang' is used,
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007885 ignoring the region.
7886 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not
7887 have to appear in 'spelllang'.
7888 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region
7889 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when
7890 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files
7891 without region name will be found.
Bram Moolenaare7566042005-06-17 22:00:15 +00007892 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7893 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007894
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007895 *'spelllang'* *'spl'*
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007896'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en")
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007897 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007898 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7899 feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01007900 A comma-separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007901 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: >
7902 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical
7903< This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words
7904 that are not recognized will be highlighted.
Bram Moolenaar911ead12019-04-21 00:03:35 +02007905 The word list name must consist of alphanumeric characters, a dash or
7906 an underscore. It should not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007907 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a
7908 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words.
7909 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is
7910 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one
7911 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian
7912 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01007913 Britain. (Note: currently en_au and en_nz dictionaries are older than
7914 en_ca, en_gb and en_us).
Bram Moolenaarcc63c642013-11-12 04:44:01 +01007915 If the name "cjk" is included East Asian characters are excluded from
7916 spell checking. This is useful when editing text that also has Asian
7917 words.
Bram Moolenaar6c391a72021-09-09 21:55:11 +02007918 Note that the "medical" dictionary does not exist, it is just an
7919 example of a longer name.
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00007920 *E757*
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00007921 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The
7922 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name
7923 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter).
7924 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct
7925 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00007926 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00007927 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the
7928 files twice.
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007929 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|.
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007930
Bram Moolenaar98692072006-02-04 00:57:42 +00007931 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name
7932 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin
7933 will ask you if you want to download the file.
7934
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007935 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files
7936 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang'
Bram Moolenaarb730f0c2018-11-25 03:56:26 +01007937 up to the first character that is not an ASCII letter or number and
7938 not a dash. Also see |set-spc-auto|.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007939
Bram Moolenaar362b44b2020-06-10 21:47:00 +02007940 *'spelloptions'* *'spo'*
7941'spelloptions' 'spo' string (default "")
7942 local to buffer
7943 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7944 feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01007945 A comma-separated list of options for spell checking:
Bram Moolenaar362b44b2020-06-10 21:47:00 +02007946 camel When a word is CamelCased, assume "Cased" is a
7947 separate word: every upper-case character in a word
7948 that comes after a lower case character indicates the
7949 start of a new word.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007950
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007951 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'*
7952'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best")
7953 global
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007954 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7955 feature}
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00007956 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007957 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of
7958 items:
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007959
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007960 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds
7961 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like
7962 scoring to improve the ordering.
7963
7964 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the
7965 results. The first method is "fast", the other method
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007966 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007967 word. That only works when the language specifies
7968 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give
7969 better results.
7970
7971 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes:
7972 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for
7973 simple typing mistakes.
7974
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00007975 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|.
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00007976 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of
7977 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines'
7978 minus two.
7979
Bram Moolenaar585ee072022-01-29 11:22:17 +00007980 timeout:{millisec} Limit the time searching for suggestions to
Dominique Pellédf62c622024-07-15 20:29:59 +02007981 {millisec} milliseconds. Applies to the following
Bram Moolenaar585ee072022-01-29 11:22:17 +00007982 methods. When omitted the limit is 5000. When
7983 negative there is no limit. {only works when built
Bram Moolenaar8a3b8052022-06-26 12:21:15 +01007984 with the |+reltime| feature}
Bram Moolenaar585ee072022-01-29 11:22:17 +00007985
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007986 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns,
7987 separated by a slash. The first column contains the
7988 bad word, the second column the suggested good word.
7989 Example:
7990 theribal/terrible ~
7991 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the
7992 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods.
7993 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for
7994 comments.
Bram Moolenaarbcb98982014-05-01 14:08:19 +02007995 The word in the second column must be correct,
7996 otherwise it will not be used. Add the word to an
7997 ".add" file if it is currently flagged as a spelling
7998 mistake.
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007999 The file is used for all languages.
8000
8001 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid
Bram Moolenaara4e0b972022-10-01 19:43:52 +01008002 trouble with spaces. Best is to call a function
8003 without arguments, see |expr-option-function|.
8004 |v:val| holds the badly spelled word. The expression
8005 must evaluate to a List of Lists, each with a
8006 suggestion and a score.
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00008007 Example:
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01008008 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]] ~
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00008009 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00008010 internal methods use. A lower score is better.
8011 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily
8012 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part.
8013 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the
8014 'verbose' option to a non-zero value.
8015
8016 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may
8017 appear several times in any order. Example: >
8018 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest()
8019<
8020 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8021 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00008022
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008023 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'*
8024'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off)
8025 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008026 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current
8027 one. |:split|
8028
Bram Moolenaar3c053a12022-10-16 13:11:12 +01008029 *'splitkeep'* *'spk'*
Luuk van Baal13ece2a2022-10-03 15:28:08 +01008030'splitkeep' 'spk' string (default "cursor")
8031 global
8032 The value of this option determines the scroll behavior when opening,
8033 closing or resizing horizontal splits.
8034
8035 Possible values are:
8036 cursor Keep the same relative cursor position.
8037 screen Keep the text on the same screen line.
8038 topline Keep the topline the same.
8039
8040 For the "screen" and "topline" values, the cursor position will be
8041 changed when necessary. In this case, the jumplist will be populated
8042 with the previous cursor position. For "screen", the text cannot always
Bram Moolenaar3c053a12022-10-16 13:11:12 +01008043 be kept on the same screen line when 'wrap' is enabled.
Luuk van Baal13ece2a2022-10-03 15:28:08 +01008044
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008045 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'*
8046'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off)
8047 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008048 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the
8049 current one. |:vsplit|
8050
8051 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'*
8052'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on)
8053 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008054 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00008055 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column
Bram Moolenaar71badf92023-04-22 22:40:14 +01008056 (if possible). This applies to the commands:
8057 - CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B, CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", "gg"
Christian Brabandtfd4e47e2024-10-06 17:57:53 +02008058 - "d", "<<", "==" and ">>" with a linewise operator
8059 (|operator-resulting-pos|)
Bram Moolenaar71badf92023-04-22 22:40:14 +01008060 - "%" with a count
8061 - buffer changing commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.)
8062 - Ex commands that only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008063 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column
8064 where it was the last time the buffer was edited.
8065 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
8066
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01008067 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E542*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008068'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty)
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00008069 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008070 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
8071 feature}
Bram Moolenaar944697a2022-02-20 19:48:20 +00008072 When non-empty, this option determines the content of the status line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008073 Also see |status-line|.
8074
8075 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with
8076 normal text. Each status line item is of the form:
8077 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item}
Bram Moolenaar5e9b2fa2016-02-01 22:37:05 +01008078 All fields except the {item} are optional. A single percent sign can
Bram Moolenaar8133cc62020-10-26 21:05:27 +01008079 be given as "%%".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008080
Yegappan Lakshmananac023e82024-11-27 20:55:45 +01008081 *stl-%!*
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00008082 When the option starts with "%!" then it is used as an expression,
8083 evaluated and the result is used as the option value. Example: >
8084 :set statusline=%!MyStatusLine()
Bram Moolenaar1c6fd1e2019-05-23 22:11:59 +02008085< The *g:statusline_winid* variable will be set to the |window-ID| of the
8086 window that the status line belongs to.
8087 The result can contain %{} items that will be evaluated too.
Bram Moolenaar61d35bd2012-03-28 20:51:51 +02008088 Note that the "%!" expression is evaluated in the context of the
8089 current window and buffer, while %{} items are evaluated in the
8090 context of the window that the statusline belongs to.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00008091
8092 When there is error while evaluating the option then it will be made
8093 empty to avoid further errors. Otherwise screen updating would loop.
Bram Moolenaar1b5f03e2023-01-09 20:12:45 +00008094 When the result contains unprintable characters the result is
8095 unpredictable.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00008096
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008097 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and
8098 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|.
8099
8100 field meaning ~
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008101 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008102 when minwid is larger than the length of the item.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008103 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008104 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'.
8105 Value must be 50 or less.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008106 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008107 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be
8108 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number
8109 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like
8110 an exponential notation.
8111 item A one letter code as described below.
8112
8113 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The
8114 second character in "item" is the type:
8115 N for number
8116 S for string
8117 F for flags as described below
8118 - not applicable
8119
8120 item meaning ~
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00008121 f S Path to the file in the buffer, as typed or relative to current
8122 directory.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008123 F S Full path to the file in the buffer.
8124 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer.
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00008125 m F Modified flag, text is "[+]"; "[-]" if 'modifiable' is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008126 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00008127 r F Readonly flag, text is "[RO]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008128 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00008129 h F Help buffer flag, text is "[help]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008130 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00008131 w F Preview window flag, text is "[Preview]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008132 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00008133 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., "[vim]". See 'filetype'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008134 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'.
Bram Moolenaar7fd73202010-07-25 16:58:46 +02008135 q S "[Quickfix List]", "[Location List]" or empty.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008136 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are
8137 being used: "<keymap>"
8138 n N Buffer number.
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01008139 b N Value of character under cursor.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008140 B N As above, in hexadecimal.
8141 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1.
8142 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added)
8143 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature}
8144 O N As above, in hexadecimal.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008145 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008146 l N Line number.
8147 L N Number of lines in buffer.
Bram Moolenaar1d59aa12020-09-19 18:50:13 +02008148 c N Column number (byte index).
8149 v N Virtual column number (screen column).
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008150 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008151 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|.
8152 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +02008153 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length, unless
8154 translated.
Luuk van Baalba936f62022-12-15 13:15:39 +00008155 S S 'showcmd' content, see 'showcmdloc'.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008156 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max})
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008157 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00008158 { NF Evaluate expression between '%{' and '}' and substitute result.
Bram Moolenaar6d150f72018-04-21 20:03:20 +02008159 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'. The
8160 expression cannot contain a '}' character, call a function to
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01008161 work around that. See |stl-%{| below.
shadmansaleh30e3de22021-05-15 17:23:28 +02008162 {% - This is almost same as { except the result of the expression is
8163 re-evaluated as a statusline format string. Thus if the
8164 return value of expr contains % items they will get expanded.
8165 The expression can contain the } character, the end of
8166 expression is denoted by %}.
Bram Moolenaar22863042021-10-16 15:23:36 +01008167 For example: >
shadmansaleh30e3de22021-05-15 17:23:28 +02008168 func! Stl_filename() abort
8169 return "%t"
8170 endfunc
8171< `stl=%{Stl_filename()}` results in `"%t"`
8172 `stl=%{%Stl_filename()%}` results in `"Name of current file"`
Bram Moolenaar22863042021-10-16 15:23:36 +01008173 %} - End of `{%` expression
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008174 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and
8175 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere.
8176 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed.
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00008177 T N For 'tabline': start of tab page N label. Use %T after the last
8178 label. This information is used for mouse clicks.
8179 X N For 'tabline': start of close tab N label. Use %X after the
8180 label, e.g.: %3Xclose%X. Use %999X for a "close current tab"
8181 mark. This information is used for mouse clicks.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008182 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start.
8183 No width fields allowed.
Yegappan Lakshmanan3ec78f92023-02-11 11:15:25 +00008184 = - Separation point between alignment sections. Each section will
8185 be separated by an equal number of spaces. With one %= what
8186 comes after it will be right-aligned. With two %= there is a
8187 middle part, with white space left and right of it.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008188 No width fields allowed.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00008189 # - Set highlight group. The name must follow and then a # again.
8190 Thus use %#HLname# for highlight group HLname. The same
8191 highlighting is used, also for the statusline of non-current
8192 windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008193 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008194 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*.
Bram Moolenaarbe4e0162023-02-02 13:59:48 +00008195 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied to
8196 StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008197 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9|
8198
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00008199 When displaying a flag, Vim removes the leading comma, if any, when
8200 that flag comes right after plaintext. This will make a nice display
8201 when flags are used like in the examples below.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008202
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008203 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008204 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will
8205 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear
8206 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. >
8207 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)...
Bram Moolenaar1c6fd1e2019-05-23 22:11:59 +02008208< Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status
8209 line is displayed.
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01008210 *stl-%{* *g:actual_curbuf* *g:actual_curwin*
Bram Moolenaarade0d392020-01-21 22:33:58 +01008211 While evaluating %{} the current buffer and current window will be set
8212 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01008213 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context.
8214 The variable "g:actual_curbuf" is set to the `bufnr()` number of the
8215 real current buffer and "g:actual_curwin" to the |window-ID| of the
8216 real current window. These values are strings.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00008217
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02008218 The 'statusline' option will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from
8219 a modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02008220 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00008221
8222 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
8223 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008224
8225 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting
8226 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by
Bram Moolenaarcfa8f9a2022-06-03 21:59:47 +01008227 using `:redrawstatus`.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008228
Bram Moolenaarcfa8f9a2022-06-03 21:59:47 +01008229 A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008230 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules
8231 described above.
8232
Bram Moolenaarcd71fa32005-03-11 22:46:48 +00008233 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008234 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008235 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim --clean" to get it right.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008236
8237 Examples:
8238 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set >
saher7b5e52d2024-10-14 19:52:50 +02008239 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%w%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008240< Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") >
8241 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P
8242< Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. >
8243 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b'
8244 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red
8245< Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded >
8246 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h...
8247< In the |:autocmd|'s: >
8248 :let b:gzflag = 1
8249< And: >
8250 :unlet b:gzflag
8251< And define this function: >
8252 :function VarExists(var, val)
8253 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif
8254 :endfunction
8255<
8256 *'suffixes'* *'su'*
8257'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj")
8258 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008259 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files
8260 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008261 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as
8262 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008263 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about
8264 including spaces and backslashes).
8265 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files.
8266 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
8267 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
8268 uses another default.
8269
8270 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'*
8271'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "")
8272 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01008273 Comma-separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008274 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: >
8275 :set suffixesadd=.java
8276<
8277 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'*
8278'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on)
8279 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008280 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008281 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with
8282 confidential information that even root must not be able to access.
8283 Careful: All text will be in memory:
8284 - Don't use this for big files.
8285 - Recovery will be impossible!
8286 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and
8287 'swapfile' is set.
8288 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is
8289 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is
8290 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created.
8291 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|.
Bram Moolenaar76f3b1a2014-03-27 22:30:07 +01008292 If you want to open a new buffer without creating a swap file for it,
8293 use the |:noswapfile| modifier.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01008294 See 'directory' for where the swap file is created.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008295
8296 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to
8297 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
8298
8299 *'swapsync'* *'sws'*
8300'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync")
8301 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008302 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008303 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008304 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and
8305 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work.
8306 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it,
8307 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some
8308 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system
8309 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default
8310 fsync(), which may work better on some systems.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00008311 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008312
8313 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'*
8314'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "")
8315 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008316 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers.
Yegappan Lakshmanan54be5fb2023-05-12 17:49:13 +01008317 This option is checked, when
8318 - jumping to errors with the |quickfix| commands (|:cc|, |:cn|, |:cp|,
h_east59858792023-10-25 22:47:05 +09008319 etc.).
Yegappan Lakshmanan54be5fb2023-05-12 17:49:13 +01008320 - jumping to a tag using the |:stag| command.
8321 - opening a file using the |CTRL-W_f| or |CTRL-W_F| command.
8322 - jumping to a buffer using a buffer split command (e.g. |:sbuffer|,
8323 |:sbnext|, or |:sbrewind|).
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01008324 Possible values (comma-separated list):
Yegappan Lakshmanan54be5fb2023-05-12 17:49:13 +01008325 useopen If included, jump to the first open window in the
8326 current tab page that contains the specified buffer
8327 (if there is one). Otherwise: Do not examine other
8328 windows.
Bram Moolenaar779b74b2006-04-10 14:55:34 +00008329 usetab Like "useopen", but also consider windows in other tab
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00008330 pages.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008331 split If included, split the current window before loading
Bram Moolenaar15146672011-10-20 22:22:38 +02008332 a buffer for a |quickfix| command that display errors.
Bram Moolenaar63b74a82019-03-24 15:09:13 +01008333 Otherwise: do not split, use current window (when used
8334 in the quickfix window: the previously used window or
8335 split if there is no other window).
Bram Moolenaara594d772015-06-19 14:41:49 +02008336 vsplit Just like "split" but split vertically.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008337 newtab Like "split", but open a new tab page. Overrules
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02008338 "split" when both are present.
Bram Moolenaar539aa6b2019-11-17 18:09:38 +01008339 uselast If included, jump to the previously used window when
8340 jumping to errors with |quickfix| commands.
Colin Kennedy21570352024-03-03 16:16:47 +01008341 If a window has 'winfixbuf' enabled, 'switchbuf' is currently not
8342 applied to the split window.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008343
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00008344 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'*
8345'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000)
8346 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00008347 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
8348 feature}
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00008349 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the
8350 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not
8351 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared.
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00008352 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one
8353 long line.
8354 Set to zero to remove the limit.
8355
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008356 *'syntax'* *'syn'*
8357'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty)
Christian Brabandt596ad662023-08-16 00:11:09 +02008358 local to buffer |local-noglobal|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008359 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
8360 feature}
8361 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless
8362 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off".
8363 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the
8364 b:current_syntax variable does).
8365 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008366 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file:
8367 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */ ~
8368 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
8369 names. Example:
8370 /* vim: set syntax=c.doxygen : */ ~
8371 This will use the "c" syntax first, then the "doxygen" syntax.
8372 Note that the second one must be prepared to be loaded as an addition,
8373 otherwise it will be skipped. More than one dot may appear.
8374 To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008375 :set syntax=OFF
8376< To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the
8377 'filetype' option: >
8378 :set syntax=ON
8379< What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the
8380 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument.
8381 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
8382 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
Millyae62fe52024-10-02 19:30:41 +02008383 Only alphanumeric characters, '.', '-' and '_' can be used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008384
LemonBoy5247b0b2024-07-12 19:30:58 +02008385 *'tabclose'* *'tcl'*
8386'tabclose' 'tcl' string (default "")
8387 global
8388 This option controls the behavior when closing tab pages (e.g., using
8389 |:tabclose|). When empty Vim goes to the next (right) tab page.
8390
8391 Possible values (comma-separated list):
8392 left If included, go to the previous tab page instead of
8393 the next one.
8394 uselast If included, go to the previously used tab page if
8395 possible. This option takes precedence over the
8396 others.
8397
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00008398 *'tabline'* *'tal'*
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00008399'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty)
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00008400 global
Bram Moolenaar944697a2022-02-20 19:48:20 +00008401 When non-empty, this option determines the content of the tab pages
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00008402 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00008403 tab pages line. See |setting-tabline| for more info.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00008404
8405 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline'
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00008406 option and only when there is no GUI tab line. When 'e' is in
8407 'guioptions' and the GUI supports a tab line 'guitablabel' is used
Bram Moolenaar7f036442010-08-15 15:24:20 +02008408 instead. Note that the two tab pages lines are very different.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00008409
8410 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use
8411 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00008412 the text to be displayed. Use "%1T" for the first label, "%2T" for
8413 the second one, etc. Use "%X" items for closing labels.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00008414
Bram Moolenaare12bab32019-01-08 22:02:56 +01008415 When changing something that is used in 'tabline' that does not
8416 trigger it to be updated, use |:redrawtabline|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02008417 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaare12bab32019-01-08 22:02:56 +01008418
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00008419 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others
8420 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows.
8421
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00008422 *'tabpagemax'* *'tpm'*
8423'tabpagemax' 'tpm' number (default 10)
8424 global
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00008425 Maximum number of tab pages to be opened by the |-p| command line
8426 argument or the ":tab all" command. |tabpage|
8427
Naruhiko Nishinobe5bd4d2025-05-14 21:20:28 +02008428 *'tabpanel'* *'tpl'* *g:actual_curtabpage*
8429'tabpanel' 'tpl' string (default empty)
8430 global
8431 {not in Vi}
Christ van Willegend65cdad2025-05-30 16:05:58 +02008432 When non-empty, this option determines the content of the |tabpanel|.
Naruhiko Nishinobe5bd4d2025-05-14 21:20:28 +02008433 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with
8434 normal text, similar to the 'statusline' or 'tabline'.
8435
8436 When changing something that is used in 'tabpanel' that does not
8437 trigger it to be updated, use |:redrawtabpanel|.
8438 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
8439
8440 You can use |g:actual_curtabpage| within a function assigned to
8441 tabpanel. |g:actual_curtabpage| represents current tab's label number.
8442 This option can contain line breaks:
8443>
8444 set tabpanel=%!TabPanel()
8445 function! TabPanel() abort
8446 return printf("(%2d)\n %%f", g:actual_curtabpage)
8447 endfunction
8448<
8449 The result is:
8450>
8451 +-----------+---------------------------------
8452 |(1) |
8453 | ~/aaa.txt|
8454 |(2) |
8455 | ~/.vimrc |
8456 | |
8457 | |
8458 | |
8459<
8460
8461 *'tabpanelopt'* *'tplo'*
8462'tabpanelopt' 'tplo' string (default "")
8463 global
8464 {not in Vi}
8465 Optional settings for the |tabpanel|, It can consist of the following
8466 items. Items must be separated by a comma.
8467
Christ van Willegend65cdad2025-05-30 16:05:58 +02008468 align:{text} Specifies the position of the tabpanel.
Naruhiko Nishinobe5bd4d2025-05-14 21:20:28 +02008469 Currently supported positions are:
8470
8471 left left-aligned
8472 right right-aligned
8473
8474 (default "left")
8475
Christ van Willegend65cdad2025-05-30 16:05:58 +02008476 columns:{n} Use the size (in characters) of the tabpanel.
Naruhiko Nishinobe5bd4d2025-05-14 21:20:28 +02008477 The tabpanel is never shown when using zero
8478 or less than the size of Vim window.
8479 (default 20)
8480
8481 vert Use a vertical separator for tabpanel.
Christ van Willegend65cdad2025-05-30 16:05:58 +02008482 This vertical separator used is "tpl_vert" of
Naruhiko Nishinobe5bd4d2025-05-14 21:20:28 +02008483 'fillchars'.
8484 (default off)
8485
8486 Examples: >
8487 :set tabpanelopt=columns:16,align:right
8488 :set tabpanelopt=
8489 :set tabpanelopt=vert,align:right
8490 :set tabpanelopt=columns:16
8491<
8492
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00008493 *'tabstop'* *'ts'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008494'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8)
8495 local to buffer
8496 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see
Bram Moolenaarf10911e2022-01-29 22:20:48 +00008497 the |:retab| command, and the 'softtabstop' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008498
8499 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file
Bram Moolenaarf10911e2022-01-29 22:20:48 +00008500 appear wrong in many places, e.g., when printing it.
8501 The value must be more than 0 and less than 10000.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008502
Song-Tianxiangab01adf2024-03-25 16:31:02 +01008503 There are five main ways to use tabs in Vim:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008504 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4
8505 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00008506 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing <Tab> and <BS> will
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008507 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters.
Bram Moolenaar10e8ff92023-06-10 21:40:39 +01008508 This is the recommended way, the file will look the same with other
8509 tools and when listing it in a terminal.
8510 2. Set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use
8511 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The
8512 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed (leave
8513 it at 8 just in case). The file will be a bit larger.
8514 You do need to check if no Tabs exist in the file. You can get rid
8515 of them by first setting 'expandtab' and using `%retab!`, making
8516 sure the value of 'tabstop' is set correctly.
8517 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008518 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The
8519 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed.
Bram Moolenaar10e8ff92023-06-10 21:40:39 +01008520 You do need to check if no Tabs exist in the file, just like in the
8521 item just above.
8522 4. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008523 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only
Bram Moolenaar10e8ff92023-06-10 21:40:39 +01008524 works when using Vim to edit the file, other tools assume a tabstop
8525 is worth 8 spaces.
8526 5. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008527 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only)
8528 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have
8529 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this
8530 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is
8531 changed.
8532
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008533 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of
8534 'tabstop' will be ignored if |'vartabstop'| is set to anything other
8535 than an empty string.
8536
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008537 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'*
8538'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on)
8539 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008540 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008541 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008542 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search
8543 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted.
8544 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that
8545 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the
8546 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off.
8547
8548 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008549 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008550 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When
8551 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done.
8552
8553 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line
8554 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: >
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008555 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some comment/
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008556< [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>]
8557
8558 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01008559 files listed in 'tags', and case is ignored or a pattern is used
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008560 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search.
8561 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only
8562 be found in the retry.
8563
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +00008564 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second,
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01008565 linear search can be avoided when case is ignored. Use a value of '2'
8566 in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be case-fold
8567 sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in the command:
Bram Moolenaar47c532e2022-03-19 15:18:53 +00008568 "sort -f -o tags tags". For Universal ctags and Exuberant ctags
8569 version 5.x or higher (at least 5.5) the --sort=foldcase switch can be
8570 used for this as well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for
8571 this to work.
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01008572
8573 By default, tag searches are case-sensitive. Case is ignored when
8574 'ignorecase' is set and 'tagcase' is "followic", or when 'tagcase' is
8575 "ignore".
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02008576 Also when 'tagcase' is "followscs" and 'smartcase' is set, or
8577 'tagcase' is "smart", and the pattern contains only lowercase
8578 characters.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008579
8580 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match
8581 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags
8582 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off.
8583 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on
8584 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above
8585 must be included in the tags file.
8586 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g.,
8587 command-line completion and ":help").
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008588
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01008589 *'tagcase'* *'tc'*
8590'tagcase' 'tc' string (default "followic")
8591 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01008592 This option specifies how case is handled when searching the tags
8593 file:
8594 followic Follow the 'ignorecase' option
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02008595 followscs Follow the 'smartcase' and 'ignorecase' options
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01008596 ignore Ignore case
8597 match Match case
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02008598 smart Ignore case unless an upper case letter is used
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01008599 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
8600 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01008601
Bram Moolenaar45e18cb2019-04-28 18:05:35 +02008602 *'tagfunc'* *'tfu'*
8603'tagfunc' 'tfu' string (default: empty)
8604 local to buffer
8605 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
8606 feature}
Christian Brabandtfb081922025-04-30 19:31:58 +02008607 This option specifies a function to be used to perform tag searches
8608 (including |taglist()|).
Bram Moolenaar45e18cb2019-04-28 18:05:35 +02008609 The function gets the tag pattern and should return a List of matching
8610 tags. See |tag-function| for an explanation of how to write the
Yegappan Lakshmanan19916a82021-11-24 16:32:55 +00008611 function and an example. The value can be the name of a function, a
8612 |lambda| or a |Funcref|. See |option-value-function| for more
8613 information.
dkearns8ebdbc92023-10-29 06:26:19 +11008614 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8615 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar45e18cb2019-04-28 18:05:35 +02008616
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008617 *'taglength'* *'tl'*
8618'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0)
8619 global
8620 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters.
8621
8622 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'*
8623'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
8624 global
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00008625 If on and using a tags file in another directory, file names in that
8626 tags file are relative to the directory where the tags file is.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008627 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
8628 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
8629
8630 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433*
8631'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with
8632 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS")
8633 global or local to buffer |global-local|
8634 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To
Yee Cheng Chin54844852023-10-09 18:12:31 +02008635 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with backslashes
8636 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces/commas and backslashes).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008637 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path
8638 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in
8639 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see
8640 |tags-option|.
8641 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in
Bram Moolenaare2b590e2010-08-08 18:29:48 +02008642 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. E.g., "/lib/**/tags" will
8643 find all files named "tags" below "/lib". The filename itself cannot
8644 contain wildcards, it is used as-is. E.g., "/lib/**/tags?" will find
Bram Moolenaar2bd9dbc2022-08-25 18:12:06 +01008645 files called "tags?".
Bram Moolenaare7eb9df2005-09-09 19:49:30 +00008646 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names
8647 actually used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008648 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag
8649 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The
8650 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case
8651 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags|
8652 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
8653 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
8654 uses another default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008655
8656 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'*
8657'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on)
8658 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008659 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or
8660 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the
8661 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or
8662 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified
8663 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry.
8664 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a
8665 mapping which should not change the tagstack.
8666
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01008667 *'tcldll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01008668'tcldll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01008669 global
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01008670 {only available when compiled with the |+tcl/dyn|
8671 feature}
8672 Specifies the name of the Tcl shared library. The default is
8673 DYNAMIC_TCL_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02008674 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01008675 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8676 security reasons.
8677
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008678 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531*
8679'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails:
8680 in the GUI: "builtin_gui"
8681 on Amiga: "amiga"
Bram Moolenaarb3f74062020-02-26 16:16:53 +01008682 on Haiku: "xterm"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008683 on Mac: "mac-ansi"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008684 on Unix: "ansi"
8685 on VMS: "ansi"
8686 on Win 32: "win32")
8687 global
8688 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control
8689 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
8690 For example: >
8691 :set term=$TERM
8692< See |termcap|.
8693
8694 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'*
8695 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'*
8696'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm")
8697 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008698 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
8699 feature}
8700 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified
8701 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping
8702 that some languages (such as Arabic) require.
8703 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when
8704 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored.
8705 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that
8706 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically.
8707 This option is reset when the GUI is started.
8708 For further details see |arabic.txt|.
8709
8710 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'*
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02008711'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ GUI: "utf-8")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008712 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008713 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character
8714 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01008715 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ('encoding' is used for the
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02008716 display).
Bram Moolenaar4b7cdca2020-01-01 16:18:38 +01008717 *E617* *E950*
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01008718 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ GUI. After the GUI has been
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008719 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8".
8720 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error
8721 message is shown.
Bram Moolenaarac360bf2015-09-01 20:31:20 +02008722 For the Win32 GUI and console versions 'termencoding' is not used,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008723 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters.
8724 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option.
8725 This is the normal value.
8726 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See
8727 |encoding-table|.
8728 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or
8729 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you
8730 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters.
8731 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and
8732 want to edit a UTF-8 file: >
8733 :let &termencoding = &encoding
8734 :set encoding=utf-8
8735< You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8.
8736
Bram Moolenaar938ae282023-02-20 20:44:55 +00008737 *'termguicolors'* *'tgc'* *'notermguicolors'* *'notgc'* *E954*
Christian Brabandtd7f58542025-01-31 16:13:14 +01008738'termguicolors' 'tgc' boolean (default off unless Vim detects that it runs
8739 in a capable terminal)
Bram Moolenaar61be73b2016-04-29 22:59:22 +02008740 global
Bram Moolenaar61be73b2016-04-29 22:59:22 +02008741 {not available when compiled without the
8742 |+termguicolors| feature}
8743 When on, uses |highlight-guifg| and |highlight-guibg| attributes in
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01008744 the terminal (thus using 24-bit color).
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01008745
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01008746 Requires a ISO-8613-3 compatible terminal. If setting this option
8747 does not work (produces a colorless UI) reading |xterm-true-color|
8748 might help.
8749
8750 For Win32 console, Windows 10 version 1703 (Creators Update) or later
8751 is required. Use this check to find out: >
8752 if has('vcon')
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01008753< This requires Vim to be built with the |+vtp| feature.
8754
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +02008755 Note that the "cterm" attributes are still used, not the "gui" ones.
Yasuhiro Matsumotoaa04e1b2022-05-07 14:09:19 +01008756
8757 When using Vim with Windows Terminal, the background of Windows
8758 Terminal is normally filled with the Vim background color. Setting
8759 'termguicolors' and the guibg of the Normal highlight group to NONE
8760 will make the background transparent: >
8761 :hi Normal guibg=NONE
8762<
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01008763 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar61be73b2016-04-29 22:59:22 +02008764
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02008765 *'termwinkey'* *'twk'*
8766'termwinkey' 'twk' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008767 local to window
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02008768 The key that starts a CTRL-W command in a terminal window. Other keys
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008769 are sent to the job running in the window.
Millya9c6f902024-10-06 16:47:02 +02008770 The key can be specified as a single character, a |key-notation| (e.g.
8771 <Up>, <C-F>) or a letter preceded with a caret (e.g. `^F` is CTRL-F): >
8772 :set twk=X
8773 :set twk=^I
8774 :set twk=<C-L>
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02008775< The string must be one key stroke but can be multiple bytes.
8776 When not set CTRL-W is used, so that CTRL-W : gets you to the command
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02008777 line. If 'termwinkey' is set to CTRL-L then CTRL-L : gets you to the
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02008778 command line.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008779
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02008780 *'termwinscroll'* *'twsl'*
8781'termwinscroll' 'twsl' number (default 10000)
8782 local to buffer
8783 {not available when compiled without the
8784 |+terminal| feature}
8785 Number of scrollback lines to keep. When going over this limit the
8786 first 10% of the scrollback lines are deleted. This is just to reduce
8787 the memory usage. See |Terminal-Normal|.
Bram Moolenaar36968af2021-11-15 17:13:11 +00008788 Also used as a limit for text sent to the terminal in one write,
8789 multiplied by the number of columns times 3 (average number of bytes
8790 per cell).
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02008791
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02008792 *'termwinsize'* *'tws'*
8793'termwinsize' 'tws' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008794 local to window
Bram Moolenaar1c6737b2020-09-07 22:18:52 +02008795 Size used when opening the |terminal| window. Format:
8796 {rows}x{columns} or {rows}*{columns}.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008797 - When empty the terminal gets the size from the window.
Bram Moolenaar498c2562018-04-15 23:45:15 +02008798 - When set with a "x" (e.g., "24x80") the terminal size is not
8799 adjusted to the window size. If the window is smaller only the
8800 top-left part is displayed.
8801 - When set with a "*" (e.g., "10*50") the terminal size follows the
8802 window size, but will not be smaller than the specified rows and/or
8803 columns.
8804 - When rows is zero then use the height of the window.
8805 - When columns is zero then use the width of the window.
8806 - Using "0x0" or "0*0" is the same as empty.
Bram Moolenaar1c6737b2020-09-07 22:18:52 +02008807 - Can be overruled in the |term_start()| options with "term_rows" and
8808 "term_cols".
Bram Moolenaar498c2562018-04-15 23:45:15 +02008809
8810 Examples:
8811 "30x0" uses 30 rows and the current window width.
8812 "20*0" uses at least 20 rows and the current window width.
8813 "0*40" uses the current window height and at least 40 columns.
Bram Moolenaar1f2903c2017-07-23 19:51:01 +02008814 Note that the command running in the terminal window may still change
8815 the size of the terminal. In that case the Vim window will be
8816 adjusted to that size, if possible.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008817
Bram Moolenaarc6ddce32019-02-08 12:47:03 +01008818 *'termwintype'* *'twt'*
8819'termwintype' 'twt' string (default "")
8820 global
Bram Moolenaarc6ddce32019-02-08 12:47:03 +01008821 {only available when compiled with the |terminal|
8822 feature on MS-Windows}
8823 Specify the virtual console (pty) used when opening the terminal
8824 window.
8825
8826 Possible values are:
Bram Moolenaard9ef1b82019-02-13 19:23:10 +01008827 "" use ConPTY if it is stable, winpty otherwise
Bram Moolenaarc6ddce32019-02-08 12:47:03 +01008828 "winpty" use winpty, fail if not supported
8829 "conpty" use |ConPTY|, fail if not supported
8830
Bram Moolenaard9ef1b82019-02-13 19:23:10 +01008831 |ConPTY| support depends on the platform. Windows 10 October 2018
8832 Update is the first version that supports ConPTY, however it is still
8833 considered unstable. ConPTY might become stable in the next release
8834 of Windows 10. winpty support needs to be installed. If neither is
Bram Moolenaarc6ddce32019-02-08 12:47:03 +01008835 supported then you cannot open a terminal window.
8836
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008837 *'terse'* *'noterse'*
8838'terse' boolean (default off)
8839 global
8840 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message
8841 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being
8842 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi
8843 shortens a lot of messages}
8844
8845 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'*
8846'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
8847 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008848 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'.
8849 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is
8850 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is
8851 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty.
8852 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
8853 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
8854
8855 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01008856'textmode' 'tx' boolean (Win32: default on,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008857 others: default off)
8858 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008859 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'.
8860 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is
8861 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to
8862 "unix".
8863
8864 *'textwidth'* *'tw'*
8865'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0)
8866 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008867 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be
8868 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02008869 this.
8870 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored
8871 when 'paste' is reset.
8872 When 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008873 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
Bram Moolenaarfc1421e2006-04-20 22:17:20 +00008874 When 'formatexpr' is set it will be used to break the line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008875 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
8876
8877 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'*
8878'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "")
8879 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008880 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
Bram Moolenaarf4d8b762021-10-17 14:13:09 +01008881 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. See
8882 |compl-thesaurus|.
Bram Moolenaarf0d58ef2018-11-16 16:13:44 +01008883
Bram Moolenaarf4d8b762021-10-17 14:13:09 +01008884 This option is not used if 'thesaurusfunc' is set, either for the
8885 buffer or globally.
Bram Moolenaarf0d58ef2018-11-16 16:13:44 +01008886
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008887 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008888 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
Bram Moolenaarf4d8b762021-10-17 14:13:09 +01008889 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes. The use of
8890 |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing directories
8891 from the list. This avoids problems when a future version uses
8892 another default. Backticks cannot be used in this option for security
8893 reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008894
Bram Moolenaar2f0936c2022-01-08 21:51:59 +00008895 *'thesaurusfunc'* *'tsrfu'*
Yegappan Lakshmanan160e9942021-10-16 15:41:29 +01008896'thesaurusfunc' 'tsrfu' string (default: empty)
Bram Moolenaarf4d8b762021-10-17 14:13:09 +01008897 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Yegappan Lakshmanan160e9942021-10-16 15:41:29 +01008898 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
8899 feature}
8900 This option specifies a function to be used for thesaurus completion
Bram Moolenaarf4d8b762021-10-17 14:13:09 +01008901 with CTRL-X CTRL-T. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T| See |compl-thesaurusfunc|.
Yegappan Lakshmanan8658c752021-12-03 11:09:29 +00008902 The value can be the name of a function, a |lambda| or a |Funcref|.
8903 See |option-value-function| for more information.
Bram Moolenaarf4d8b762021-10-17 14:13:09 +01008904
Yegappan Lakshmanan160e9942021-10-16 15:41:29 +01008905 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8906 security reasons.
8907
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008908 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'*
8909'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off)
8910 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008911 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator.
8912 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
8913
8914 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'*
8915'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on)
8916 global
laburnumT3f7855a2023-12-05 18:37:03 +01008917
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008918 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'*
Bram Moolenaar94237492017-04-23 18:40:21 +02008919'ttimeout' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008920 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008921 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a
8922 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received:
8923
8924 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~
8925 off off do not time out
8926 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes
8927 off on time out on key codes
8928
8929 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete
8930 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there
8931 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For
8932 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next
8933 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'.
8934 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for
8935 the next character to arrive. After that the already received
8936 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can
8937 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option.
8938 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause
8939 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits
8940 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start
8941 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have
8942 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key
8943 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and
8944 reset the 'timeout' option.
8945
8946 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
8947
8948 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'*
8949'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000)
8950 global
Bram Moolenaar25c9c682019-05-05 18:13:34 +02008951
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008952 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'*
Bram Moolenaar94237492017-04-23 18:40:21 +02008953'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1, set to 100 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008954 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008955 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key
8956 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G
8957 when part of a command has been typed.
8958 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a
8959 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to
8960 a non-negative number.
8961
8962 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~
8963 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen'
8964 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen'
8965
8966 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options
8967 tell so. A useful setting would be >
8968 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100
8969< (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after
8970 a tenth of a second).
8971
8972 *'title'* *'notitle'*
8973'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
8974 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008975 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of
8976 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to:
8977 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM
8978 Where:
8979 filename the name of the file being edited
8980 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off
8981 + indicates the file was modified
8982 = indicates the file is read-only
8983 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified
8984 (path) is the path of the file being edited
8985 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM"
8986 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles
8987 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and
Bram Moolenaard1caa942020-04-10 22:10:56 +02008988 terminals with a non-empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008989 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap).
8990 *X11*
8991 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
8992 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11"
8993 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also
8994 works for the icon name |'icon'|.
8995 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title
8996 will not work (except in the GUI).
8997 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'.
8998 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then.
Christian Brabandt1b7fbe72024-01-30 20:41:07 +01008999 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command: >
9000
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009001 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY &
Christian Brabandt1b7fbe72024-01-30 20:41:07 +01009002 ssh -X machine_name xterm &
9003<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009004 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the
9005 title of the window should change back to what it should be after
9006 exiting Vim.
9007
9008 *'titlelen'*
9009'titlelen' number (default 85)
9010 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009011 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009012 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is
9013 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009014 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But
9015 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters
9016 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title
9017 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise,
9018 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used.
9019 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option.
9020
9021 *'titleold'*
9022'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim")
9023 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009024 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the
9025 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or
9026 'titlestring' is not empty.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00009027 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
9028 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009029 *'titlestring'*
9030'titlestring' string (default "")
9031 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009032 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the
9033 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on.
9034 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently
9035 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a
9036 non-empty 't_ts' option).
9037 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +01009038 be restored if possible, see |X11|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02009039
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009040 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
Milly6c2fc372024-10-16 22:11:17 +02009041 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. If it contains
9042 an invalid '%' format, the value is used as-is and no error or warning
9043 will be given when the value is set.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02009044 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
9045
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009046 Example: >
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00009047 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() .. "/" .. expand("%:p")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009048 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70
9049< The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right
9050 of the available space.
9051 Some people prefer to have the file name first: >
9052 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%)
9053< Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009054 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009055 separating space only when needed.
9056 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display
9057 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character).
9058 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
9059
9060 *'toolbar'* *'tb'*
9061'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips")
9062 global
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01009063 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Motif| and |+GUI_Photon|}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009064 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009065 possible values are:
9066 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons.
9067 text Toolbar buttons shown with text.
9068 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009069 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009070 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons.
9071 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse
9072 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment.
9073
9074 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the
9075 following: >
9076 :set tb=icons,text
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01009077< Motif cannot display icons and text at the same time. They
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009078 will show icons if both are requested.
9079
9080 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if
9081 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable
9082 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: >
9083 :set guioptions-=T
9084< Also see |gui-toolbar|.
9085
9086 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'*
9087'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small")
9088 global
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01009089 {only in the GTK+ GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009090 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are:
Bram Moolenaar77cdfd12016-03-12 12:57:59 +01009091 tiny Use tiny icons.
9092 small Use small icons (default).
9093 medium Use medium-sized icons.
9094 large Use large icons.
9095 huge Use even larger icons.
9096 giant Use very big icons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009097 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on
Bram Moolenaar77cdfd12016-03-12 12:57:59 +01009098 the current theme. Common dimensions are giant=48x48, huge=32x32,
9099 large=24x24, medium=24x24, small=20x20 and tiny=16x16.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009100
9101 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined
9102 by user preferences or the current theme is used.
9103
9104 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'*
9105'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on)
9106 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009107 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones.
9108 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones.
9109 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for
9110 the change to take effect, for example: >
9111 :set notbi term=$TERM
9112< See also |termcap|.
9113 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin
9114 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty
9115 xterm entries...).
9116
9117 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'*
Bram Moolenaarc1cf4c92022-11-25 15:09:35 +00009118'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default on)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009119 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009120 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to
9121 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line
9122 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple
9123 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region.
9124 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen
9125 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the
9126 mouse in an xterm and other terminals.
9127
Bram Moolenaarc1cf4c92022-11-25 15:09:35 +00009128 The default used to be set only for some terminal names, but these
9129 days nearly all terminals are fast, therefore the default is now "on".
9130 If you have a slow connection you may want to set this option off,
9131 e.g. depending on the host name: >
9132 if hostname() =~ 'faraway'
9133 set nottyfast
9134 endif
9135<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009136 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'*
9137'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term')
9138 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009139 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not
9140 available when compiled without |+mouse|}
9141 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized.
Bram Moolenaar2c7a7632007-05-10 18:19:11 +00009142 Currently these strings are valid:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009143 *xterm-mouse*
9144 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates
9145 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes:
9146 "s" = button state
9147 "c" = column plus 33
9148 "r" = row plus 33
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02009149 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec",
9150 "urxvt", and "sgr" for solutions.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009151 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the
9152 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works
9153 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00009154 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009155 work. See below for how Vim detects this
9156 automatically.
9157 *netterm-mouse*
Bram Moolenaar25c9c682019-05-05 18:13:34 +02009158 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. A left mouse click generates
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009159 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers
Bram Moolenaar25c9c682019-05-05 18:13:34 +02009160 for the row and column. No other mouse events are
9161 supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009162 *dec-mouse*
9163 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a
9164 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[".
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00009165 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was
9166 configured with "--enable-dec-locator".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009167 *jsbterm-mouse*
9168 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling.
9169 *pterm-mouse*
9170 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009171 *urxvt-mouse*
9172 urxvt Mouse handling for the urxvt (rxvt-unicode) terminal.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02009173 The mouse works only if the terminal supports this
9174 encoding style, but it does not have 223 columns limit
9175 unlike "xterm" or "xterm2".
Bram Moolenaar9b451252012-08-15 17:43:31 +02009176 *sgr-mouse*
9177 sgr Mouse handling for the terminal that emits SGR-styled
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02009178 mouse reporting. The mouse works even in columns
9179 beyond 223. This option is backward compatible with
9180 "xterm2" because it can also decode "xterm2" style
9181 mouse codes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009182
9183 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm|
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02009184 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm| |+mouse_jsbterm| |+mouse_urxvt|
9185 |+mouse_sgr|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009186 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always
9187 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes
9188 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02009189 "xterm", "xterm2", "urxvt" or "sgr" (because dec mouse codes conflict
9190 with them).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009191 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is
Bram Moolenaar45758762016-10-12 23:08:06 +02009192 set to a name that starts with "xterm", "mlterm", "screen", "tmux",
9193 "st" (full match only), "st-" or "stterm", and 'ttymouse' is not set
9194 already.
Bram Moolenaar06cd14d2023-01-10 12:37:38 +00009195 If the terminfo/termcap entry "XM" exists and the first number is
9196 "1006" then 'ttymouse' will be set to "sgr". This works for many
9197 modern terminals.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02009198 Additionally, if vim is compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and
9199 |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the xterm version
Bram Moolenaarf8a07122019-07-01 22:06:07 +02009200 number, more intelligent detection is done.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009201 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be
Bram Moolenaard47d5222018-12-09 20:43:55 +01009202 from 95 to 276. The "sgr" value will be set if Vim detects Mac
9203 Terminal.app, iTerm2 or mintty, and when the xterm version is 277 or
9204 higher.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02009205 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" or "sgr"
9206 automatically, set t_RV to an empty string: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009207 :set t_RV=
9208<
9209 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'*
9210'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999)
9211 global
9212 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines
9213 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is
9214 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number,
9215 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying.
9216
9217 *'ttytype'* *'tty'*
9218'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM)
9219 global
9220 Alias for 'term', see above.
9221
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02009222 *'undodir'* *'udir'*
9223'undodir' 'udir' string (default ".")
9224 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02009225 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02009226 List of directory names for undo files, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaarb230bd52010-05-25 21:02:00 +02009227 See |'backupdir'| for details of the format.
Bram Moolenaar6a244fe2010-05-24 22:02:24 +02009228 "." means using the directory of the file. The undo file name for
9229 "file.txt" is ".file.txt.un~".
9230 For other directories the file name is the full path of the edited
9231 file, with path separators replaced with "%".
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02009232 When writing: The first directory that exists is used. "." always
9233 works, no directories after "." will be used for writing.
9234 When reading all entries are tried to find an undo file. The first
9235 undo file that exists is used. When it cannot be read an error is
9236 given, no further entry is used.
9237 See |undo-persistence|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02009238 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
9239 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02009240
Bram Moolenaar543b7ef2013-06-01 14:50:56 +02009241 *'undofile'* *'noundofile'* *'udf'* *'noudf'*
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02009242'undofile' 'udf' boolean (default off)
9243 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02009244 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02009245 When on, Vim automatically saves undo history to an undo file when
9246 writing a buffer to a file, and restores undo history from the same
9247 file on buffer read.
Bram Moolenaarb230bd52010-05-25 21:02:00 +02009248 The directory where the undo file is stored is specified by 'undodir'.
9249 For more information about this feature see |undo-persistence|.
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02009250 The undo file is not read when 'undoreload' causes the buffer from
9251 before a reload to be saved for undo.
Bram Moolenaar97d62492012-11-15 21:28:22 +01009252 When 'undofile' is turned off the undo file is NOT deleted.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01009253 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02009254
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009255 *'undolevels'* *'ul'*
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01009256'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS and Win32)
Bram Moolenaarf5a2fd82013-11-06 05:26:15 +01009257 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009258 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information
Bram Moolenaar5be4cee2019-09-27 19:34:08 +02009259 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used.
9260 Nevertheless, a single change can already use a large amount of memory.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009261 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes
9262 itself: >
9263 set ul=0
9264< But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in
9265 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo.
Bram Moolenaar945e2db2010-06-05 17:43:32 +02009266 Also see |undo-two-ways|.
Bram Moolenaarf5a2fd82013-11-06 05:26:15 +01009267 Set to -1 for no undo at all. You might want to do this only for the
9268 current buffer: >
9269 setlocal ul=-1
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009270< This helps when you run out of memory for a single change.
Bram Moolenaar32efaf62014-11-05 17:02:17 +01009271
9272 The local value is set to -123456 when the global value is to be used.
9273
Bram Moolenaar945e2db2010-06-05 17:43:32 +02009274 Also see |clear-undo|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009275
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02009276 *'undoreload'* *'ur'*
9277'undoreload' 'ur' number (default 10000)
9278 global
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02009279 Save the whole buffer for undo when reloading it. This applies to the
9280 ":e!" command and reloading for when the buffer changed outside of
9281 Vim. |FileChangedShell|
Bram Moolenaar24a98a02017-09-27 22:23:55 +02009282 The save only happens when this option is negative or when the number
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02009283 of lines is smaller than the value of this option.
9284 Set this option to zero to disable undo for a reload.
9285
9286 When saving undo for a reload, any undo file is not read.
9287
9288 Note that this causes the whole buffer to be stored in memory. Set
9289 this option to a lower value if you run out of memory.
9290
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009291 *'updatecount'* *'uc'*
9292'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200)
9293 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009294 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to
9295 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on
9296 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting
9297 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly
9298 mode this option will be initialized to 10000.
9299 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|.
9300 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are
9301 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount'
9302 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted.
9303 Also see |'swapsync'|.
9304 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile"
9305 or "nowrite".
9306
9307 *'updatetime'* *'ut'*
9308'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000)
9309 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009310 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be
9311 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the
9312 |CursorHold| autocommand event.
9313
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02009314 *'varsofttabstop'* *'vsts'*
9315'varsofttabstop' 'vsts' string (default "")
9316 local to buffer
9317 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs|
9318 feature}
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02009319 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while editing,
9320 such as inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like variable-
9321 width <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mixture of spaces
9322 and <Tab>s is used. Tab widths are separated with commas, with the
9323 final value applying to all subsequent tabs.
9324
9325 For example, when editing assembly language files where statements
Bram Moolenaar6dc819b2018-07-03 16:42:19 +02009326 start in the 9th column and comments in the 41st, it may be useful
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02009327 to use the following: >
9328 :set varsofttabstop=8,32,8
Bram Moolenaar6dc819b2018-07-03 16:42:19 +02009329< This will set soft tabstops with 8 and 8 + 32 spaces, and 8 more
9330 for every column thereafter.
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02009331
9332 Note that the value of |'softtabstop'| will be ignored while
9333 'varsofttabstop' is set.
9334
9335 *'vartabstop'* *'vts'*
9336'vartabstop' 'vts' string (default "")
9337 local to buffer
9338 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs|
9339 feature}
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02009340 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for,
9341 separated by commas. Each value corresponds to one tab, with the
9342 final value applying to all subsequent tabs. For example: >
9343 :set vartabstop=4,20,10,8
9344< This will make the first tab 4 spaces wide, the second 20 spaces,
9345 the third 10 spaces, and all following tabs 8 spaces.
9346
9347 Note that the value of |'tabstop'| will be ignored while 'vartabstop'
9348 is set.
9349
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009350 *'verbose'* *'vbs'*
9351'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0)
9352 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009353 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing.
9354 Currently, these messages are given:
9355 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written.
9356 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed.
Bram Moolenaar647a5302020-05-03 17:01:24 +02009357 >= 4 Shell commands.
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00009358 >= 5 Every searched tags file and include file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009359 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed.
9360 >= 9 Every executed autocommand.
Bram Moolenaar647a5302020-05-03 17:01:24 +02009361 >= 11 Finding items in a path
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009362 >= 12 Every executed function.
9363 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded.
9364 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause.
Bram Moolenaar823654b2020-05-29 23:03:09 +02009365 >= 15 Every executed Ex command from a script (truncated at 200
9366 characters).
Bram Moolenaare7b1ea02020-08-07 19:54:59 +02009367 >= 16 Every executed Ex command.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009368
9369 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|.
9370 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command.
9371
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00009372 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not
9373 displayed.
9374
9375 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'*
9376'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty)
9377 global
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00009378 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name.
9379 When the file exists messages are appended.
9380 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made
Bram Moolenaar80794b12010-06-13 05:20:42 +02009381 empty. Writes are buffered, thus may not show up for some time.
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00009382 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first.
9383 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not
9384 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set.
dkearns8ebdbc92023-10-29 06:26:19 +11009385 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
9386 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00009387
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009388 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'*
h_east59858792023-10-25 22:47:05 +09009389'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga: "home:vimfiles/view",
Bram Moolenaar801961d2023-06-23 16:15:13 +01009390 for Win32: "$HOME/vimfiles/view",
Christian Brabandtc3e6e392024-05-04 09:48:15 +02009391 for Unix: "$HOME/.vim/view" or
9392 "$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/vim/view"
Bram Moolenaar801961d2023-06-23 16:15:13 +01009393 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009394 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02009395 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009396 feature}
9397 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|.
Christian Brabandtc3e6e392024-05-04 09:48:15 +02009398 For $XDG_CONFIG_HOME see |xdg-base-dir|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009399 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
9400 security reasons.
9401
9402 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'*
Bram Moolenaar13e90412017-11-11 18:16:48 +01009403'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor,curdir")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009404 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02009405 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009406 feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01009407 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma-separated
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009408 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009409 word save and restore ~
9410 cursor cursor position in file and in window
9411 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
9412 fold options
9413 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
9414 global values for local options)
Bram Moolenaar6e932462014-09-09 18:48:09 +02009415 localoptions same as "options"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009416 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
9417 slashes
9418 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01009419 on MS-Windows
Bram Moolenaar13e90412017-11-11 18:16:48 +01009420 curdir the window-local directory, if set with `:lcd`
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009421
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01009422 "slash" and "unix" are useful on MS-Windows when sharing view files
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009423 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01009424 but the MS-Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009425
9426 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01009427'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for
9428 MS-Windows: '100,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:,
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01009429 for Amiga: '100,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:
9430 for others: '100,<50,s10,h)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009431 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02009432 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009433 feature}
9434 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02009435 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). Except when 'viminfofile' is
9436 "NONE".
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01009437 The string should be a comma-separated list of parameters, each
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02009438 consisting of a single character identifying the particular parameter,
9439 followed by a number or string which specifies the value of that
9440 parameter. If a particular character is left out, then the default
9441 value is used for that parameter. The following is a list of the
9442 identifying characters and the effect of their value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009443 CHAR VALUE ~
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009444 *viminfo-!*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009445 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start
9446 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase
9447 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis"
Bram Moolenaar680eeca2010-10-20 17:44:42 +02009448 and "_K_L_M" are not. Nested List and Dict items may not be
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01009449 read back correctly, you end up with an empty item.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009450 *viminfo-quote*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009451 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of
9452 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a
9453 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the
9454 start of a comment!
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009455 *viminfo-%*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009456 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is
9457 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not
9458 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the
Bram Moolenaard042dc82015-11-24 19:18:36 +01009459 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Quickfix
9460 ('buftype'), unlisted ('buflisted'), unnamed and buffers on
9461 removable media (|viminfo-r|) are not saved.
Bram Moolenaar15d0a8c2004-09-06 17:44:46 +00009462 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum
9463 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all
9464 buffers are stored.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009465 *viminfo-'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009466 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks
9467 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when
9468 'viminfo' is non-empty.
9469 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the
9470 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009471 *viminfo-/*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009472 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009473 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009474 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of
9475 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009476 *viminfo-:*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009477 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009478 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009479 *viminfo-<*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009480 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then
9481 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are
9482 saved. '"' is the old name for this item.
9483 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009484 *viminfo-@*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009485 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009486 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009487 *viminfo-c*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009488 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the
9489 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00009490 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009491 *viminfo-f*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009492 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0
9493 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009494 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009495 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo").
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009496 *viminfo-h*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009497 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo
9498 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch"
9499 has been used since the last search command.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009500 *viminfo-n*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009501 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02009502 the 'n'. Must be at the end of the option! If the
9503 'viminfofile' option is set, that file name overrides the one
9504 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are
Bram Moolenaar063b9d12016-07-09 20:21:48 +02009505 expanded when opening the file, not when setting the option.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009506 *viminfo-r*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009507 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next
9508 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each
9509 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01009510 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-Windows you
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009511 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can
9512 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is
9513 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50
9514 characters.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01009515 *viminfo-s*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009516 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are
9517 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default
9518 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text.
9519 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit.
9520
9521 Example: >
9522 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo
9523<
9524 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you
9525 edited.
9526 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be
9527 remembered.
9528 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped.
9529 :0 Command-line history will not be saved.
9530 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo".
9531 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used,
9532 that is, save all of the search history, and also the
9533 previous search and substitute patterns.
9534 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back.
9535 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored.
9536
9537 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to
9538 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically.
9539
9540 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
9541 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01009542 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
9543 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009544
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02009545 *'viminfofile'* *'vif'*
9546'viminfofile' 'vif' string (default: "")
9547 global
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02009548 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
9549 feature}
9550 When non-empty, overrides the file name used for viminfo.
9551 When equal to "NONE" no viminfo file will be read or written.
9552 This option can be set with the |-i| command line flag. The |--clean|
9553 command line flag sets it to "NONE".
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02009554 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
9555 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02009556
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009557 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'*
9558'virtualedit' 've' string (default "")
Gary Johnson51ad8502021-08-03 18:33:08 +02009559 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01009560 A comma-separated list of these words:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009561 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode.
9562 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode.
9563 all Allow virtual editing in all modes.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00009564 onemore Allow the cursor to move just past the end of the line
Gary Johnson53ba05b2021-07-26 22:19:10 +02009565 none When used as the local value, do not allow virtual
9566 editing even when the global value is set. When used
9567 as the global value, "none" is the same as "".
9568 NONE Alternative spelling of "none".
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00009569
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009570 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00009571 no actual character. This can be halfway into a tab or beyond the end
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009572 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and
9573 editing a table.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00009574 "onemore" is not the same, it will only allow moving the cursor just
9575 after the last character of the line. This makes some commands more
9576 consistent. Previously the cursor was always past the end of the line
9577 if the line was empty. But it is far from Vi compatible. It may also
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00009578 break some plugins or Vim scripts. For example because |l| can move
9579 the cursor after the last character. Use with care!
Bram Moolenaar9ba7e172013-07-17 22:37:26 +02009580 Using the `$` command will move to the last character in the line, not
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00009581 past it. This may actually move the cursor to the left!
Bram Moolenaar9ba7e172013-07-17 22:37:26 +02009582 The `g$` command will move to the end of the screen line.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00009583 It doesn't make sense to combine "all" with "onemore", but you will
9584 not get a warning for it.
Bram Moolenaar53f7fcc2021-07-28 20:10:16 +02009585 When combined with other words, "none" is ignored.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01009586 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009587
9588 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep*
9589'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off)
9590 global
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02009591 Use a visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009592 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted,
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02009593 use: >
9594 :set vb t_vb=
9595< If you want a short flash, you can use this on many terminals: >
9596 :set vb t_vb=[?5h$<100>[?5l
9597< Here $<100> specifies the time, you can use a smaller or bigger value
9598 to get a shorter or longer flash.
9599
9600 Note: Vim will limit the bell to once per half a second. This avoids
9601 having to wait for the flashing to finish when there are lots of
9602 bells, e.g. on key repeat. This also happens without 'visualbell'
9603 set.
9604
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009605 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display
9606 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f",
9607 where 40 is the time in msec.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02009608
9609 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You
9610 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|.
9611
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009612 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash.
9613 Also see 'errorbells'.
9614
9615 *'warn'* *'nowarn'*
9616'warn' boolean (default on)
9617 global
9618 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer
9619 has been changed.
9620
9621 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'*
9622'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off)
9623 global
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00009624 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009625 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x.
9626 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and
9627 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running.
9628
9629 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'*
9630'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "")
9631 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009632 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the
9633 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in
9634 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys:
9635 char key mode ~
9636 b <BS> Normal and Visual
9637 s <Space> Normal and Visual
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00009638 h "h" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
9639 l "l" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009640 < <Left> Normal and Visual
9641 > <Right> Normal and Visual
9642 ~ "~" Normal
9643 [ <Left> Insert and Replace
9644 ] <Right> Insert and Replace
9645 For example: >
9646 :set ww=<,>,[,]
9647< allows wrap only when cursor keys are used.
9648 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change
9649 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h"
9650 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This
9651 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and
9652 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping
9653 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the
9654 cursor.
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00009655 When 'l' is included and it is used after an operator at the end of a
Bram Moolenaar589edb32019-09-20 14:38:13 +02009656 line (not an empty line) then it will not move to the next line. This
9657 makes "dl", "cl", "yl" etc. work normally.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009658 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
9659 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
9660
9661 *'wildchar'* *'wc'*
9662'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E)
9663 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009664 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the
9665 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00009666 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009667 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See
9668 'wildcharm' for that.
Bram Moolenaar34cc7d82021-09-21 20:09:51 +02009669 Some keys will not work, such as CTRL-C, <CR> and Enter.
Yee Cheng Chin8f4fb002023-10-17 10:06:56 +02009670 <Esc> can be used, but hitting it twice in a row will still exit
9671 command-line as a failsafe measure.
Millya9c6f902024-10-06 16:47:02 +02009672 Although 'wc' is a number option, it can be specified as a number, a
9673 single character, a |key-notation| (e.g. <Up>, <C-F>) or a letter
9674 preceded with a caret (e.g. `^F` is CTRL-F): >
9675 :set wc=27
9676 :set wc=X
9677 :set wc=^I
Bram Moolenaar34cc7d82021-09-21 20:09:51 +02009678 :set wc=<Tab>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009679< NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
9680 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
9681
9682 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'*
9683'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0))
9684 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009685 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00009686 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line
9687 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009688 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that
9689 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: >
9690 :set wcm=<C-Z>
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00009691 :cnoremap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009692< Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N.
9693
9694 *'wildignore'* *'wig'*
9695'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "")
9696 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009697 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02009698 patterns is ignored when expanding |wildcards|, completing file or
9699 directory names, and influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and
9700 |globpath()| unless a flag is passed to disable this.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009701 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
9702 Also see 'suffixes'.
9703 Example: >
9704 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj
9705< The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
9706 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
9707 uses another default.
9708
h_east596a9f22023-11-21 21:24:23 +09009709 *'wildignorecase'* *'wic'* *'nowildignorecase'* *'nowic'*
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01009710'wildignorecase' 'wic' boolean (default off)
9711 global
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01009712 When set case is ignored when completing file names and directories.
Bram Moolenaar71afbfe2013-03-19 16:49:16 +01009713 Has no effect when 'fileignorecase' is set.
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01009714 Does not apply when the shell is used to expand wildcards, which
9715 happens when there are special characters.
9716
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009717 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'*
Luca Saccarola437bc132024-11-14 21:21:17 +01009718'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default on)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009719 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009720 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced
9721 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion,
Bram Moolenaar54162322022-08-26 16:58:51 +01009722 the possible matches are shown.
9723 When 'wildoptions' contains "pum", then the completion matches are
9724 shown in a popup menu. Otherwise they are displayed just above the
9725 command line, with the first match highlighted (overwriting the status
9726 line, if there is one).
Yegappan Lakshmanan3908ef52022-02-08 12:08:07 +00009727 Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009728 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match.
9729 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is
9730 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode.
Bram Moolenaar26402cb2013-02-20 21:26:00 +01009731 You can check the current mode with |wildmenumode()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009732 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on
9733 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls
9734 as needed.
9735 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used
9736 for selecting a completion.
Yee Cheng Chin2bbd0d32023-10-14 02:23:45 -07009737 While the "wildmenu" is active, the following keys have special
9738 meanings:
9739 CTRL-P - go to the previous entry
9740 CTRL-N - go to the next entry
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009741 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a
9742 dot: move into a submenu.
Yee Cheng Chin209ec902023-10-17 10:56:25 +02009743 CTRL-E - end completion, go back to what was there before
9744 selecting a match.
9745 CTRL-Y - accept the currently selected match and stop
9746 completion.
Yee Cheng Chin2bbd0d32023-10-14 02:23:45 -07009747
9748 When not using the popup menu for command line completion, the
9749 following keys have special meanings:
9750 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009751 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into
9752 parent directory or parent menu.
Yee Cheng Chin2bbd0d32023-10-14 02:23:45 -07009753 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a
9754 subdirectory or submenu.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009755
Yegappan Lakshmanan3908ef52022-02-08 12:08:07 +00009756 When using the popup menu for command line completion, the following
9757 keys have special meanings:
Yee Cheng Chin2bbd0d32023-10-14 02:23:45 -07009758 <Up> <Down> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N)
zeertzjq3c81f472023-10-15 16:02:08 +08009759 <PageUp> - select a match several entries back
9760 <PageDown> - select a match several entries further
Yegappan Lakshmanan3908ef52022-02-08 12:08:07 +00009761 <Left> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into
9762 parent directory or parent menu.
9763 <Right> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a
9764 subdirectory or submenu.
Yegappan Lakshmanan3908ef52022-02-08 12:08:07 +00009765
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009766 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|.
9767
9768 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead
9769 of selecting a different match, use this: >
9770 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left>
9771 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right>
9772<
9773 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match
9774 |hl-WildMenu|.
9775
9776 *'wildmode'* *'wim'*
9777'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full")
9778 global
Girish Palyaeded3362025-04-12 18:03:32 +02009779 Completion mode used for the character specified with 'wildchar'.
9780 This option is a comma-separated list of up to four parts,
9781 corresponding to the first, second, third, and fourth presses of
9782 'wildchar'. Each part is a colon-separated list of completion
9783 behaviors, which are applied simultaneously during that phase.
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02009784
Girish Palyaeded3362025-04-12 18:03:32 +02009785 The possible behavior values are:
9786 "" Only complete (insert) the first match. No further
9787 matches are cycled or listed.
9788 "full" Complete the next full match. Cycles through all
9789 matches, returning to the original input after the
9790 last match. If 'wildmenu' is enabled, it will be
9791 shown.
9792 "longest" Complete to the longest common substring. If this
9793 doesn't extend the input, the next 'wildmode' part is
9794 used.
9795 "list" If multiple matches are found, list all of them.
9796 "lastused" When completing buffer names, sort them by most
9797 recently used (excluding the current buffer). Only
9798 applies to buffer name completion.
9799 "noselect" If 'wildmenu' is enabled, show the menu but do not
9800 preselect the first item.
Christian Brabandtf4b1a602025-04-13 18:06:49 +02009801 If only one match exists, it is completed fully, unless "noselect" is
Girish Palyaeded3362025-04-12 18:03:32 +02009802 specified.
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02009803
Girish Palyaeded3362025-04-12 18:03:32 +02009804 Some useful combinations of colon-separated values:
9805 "longest:full" Start with the longest common string and show
9806 'wildmenu' (if enabled). Does not cycle
9807 through full matches.
9808 "list:full" List all matches and complete first match.
9809 "list:longest" List all matches and complete till the longest
9810 common prefix.
9811 "list:lastused" List all matches. When completing buffers,
9812 sort them by most recently used (excluding the
9813 current buffer).
9814 "noselect:lastused" Do not preselect the first item in 'wildmenu'
9815 if it is active. When completing buffers,
9816 sort them by most recently used (excluding the
9817 current buffer).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009818
9819 Examples: >
9820 :set wildmode=full
Girish Palyaeded3362025-04-12 18:03:32 +02009821< Complete full match on every press (default behavior) >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009822 :set wildmode=longest,full
Girish Palyaeded3362025-04-12 18:03:32 +02009823< First press: longest common substring
9824 Second press: cycle through full matches >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009825 :set wildmode=list:full
Girish Palyaeded3362025-04-12 18:03:32 +02009826< First press: list all matches and complete the first one >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009827 :set wildmode=list,full
Girish Palyaeded3362025-04-12 18:03:32 +02009828< First press: list matches only
9829 Second press: complete full matches >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009830 :set wildmode=longest,list
Girish Palyaeded3362025-04-12 18:03:32 +02009831< First press: longest common substring
9832 Second press: list all matches >
Girish Palya2bacc3e2025-03-02 22:55:57 +01009833 :set wildmode=noselect:full
Hirohito Higashifa8b7db2025-04-30 19:12:37 +02009834< First press: show 'wildmenu' without completing or selecting
9835 Second press: cycle full matches >
Girish Palya2bacc3e2025-03-02 22:55:57 +01009836 :set wildmode=noselect:lastused,full
Christian Brabandtf4b1a602025-04-13 18:06:49 +02009837< Same as above, but buffer matches are sorted by time last used
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00009838 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009839
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00009840 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'*
9841'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "")
9842 global
Yegappan Lakshmanan3908ef52022-02-08 12:08:07 +00009843 A list of words that change how |cmdline-completion| is done.
9844 The following values are supported:
Bram Moolenaar1588bc82022-03-08 21:35:07 +00009845 fuzzy Use |fuzzy-matching| to find completion matches. When
Yegappan Lakshmanan38b85cb2022-02-24 13:28:41 +00009846 this value is specified, wildcard expansion will not
9847 be used for completion. The matches will be sorted by
9848 the "best match" rather than alphabetically sorted.
9849 This will find more matches than the wildcard
9850 expansion. Currently fuzzy matching based completion
9851 is not supported for file and directory names and
9852 instead wildcard expansion is used.
Bram Moolenaar8a3b8052022-06-26 12:21:15 +01009853 pum Display the completion matches using the popup menu
Yegappan Lakshmanan3908ef52022-02-08 12:08:07 +00009854 in the same style as the |ins-completion-menu|.
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00009855 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00009856 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00009857 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are:
9858 d #define
9859 f function
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00009860
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009861 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'*
9862'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu")
9863 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009864 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI}
9865 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT
9866 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the
9867 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and
9868 entering special characters. This option tells what to do:
9869 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be
9870 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be
9871 done with the |:simalt| command.
9872 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key
9873 combinations cannot be mapped.
9874 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009875 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009876 keys can be mapped.
9877 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT
9878 key is never used for the menu.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00009879 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will
9880 select the menu, unless it has been mapped.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009881
Bram Moolenaar4d784b22019-05-25 19:51:39 +02009882 *'wincolor'* *'wcr'*
9883'wincolor' 'wcr' string (default empty)
9884 local to window
9885 Highlight group name to use for this window instead of the Normal
9886 color |hl-Normal|.
9887
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00009888 *'window'* *'wi'*
9889'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1)
9890 global
Bram Moolenaardad44732021-03-31 20:07:33 +02009891 Window height used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one
9892 window and the value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen
9893 will scroll 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00009894 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll
9895 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines.
Luuk van Baal5a2e3ec2024-03-28 10:07:29 +01009896 When resizing the Vim window, and the value is smaller than 1 or more
9897 than or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1.
Bram Moolenaardad44732021-03-31 20:07:33 +02009898 Note: Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window, use
9899 'lines' for that.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00009900
Colin Kennedy21570352024-03-03 16:16:47 +01009901 *'winfixbuf'*
9902'winfixbuf' 'wfb' boolean (default off)
9903 local to window
zeertzjq0049a492024-03-11 23:13:16 +08009904 If enabled, the window and the buffer it is displaying are paired.
Colin Kennedy21570352024-03-03 16:16:47 +01009905 For example, attempting to change the buffer with |:edit| will fail.
9906 Other commands which change a window's buffer such as |:cnext| will
zeertzjq0049a492024-03-11 23:13:16 +08009907 also skip any window with 'winfixbuf' enabled. However if an Ex
9908 command has a "!" modifier, it can force switching buffers.
Colin Kennedy21570352024-03-03 16:16:47 +01009909
laburnumT3f7855a2023-12-05 18:37:03 +01009910 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'*
9911'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off)
9912 local to window |local-noglobal|
9913 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and
9914 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. Set by default for the
9915 |preview-window| and |quickfix-window|.
9916 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room.
9917
9918 *'winfixwidth'* *'wfw'* *'nowinfixwidth'* *'nowfw'*
9919'winfixwidth' 'wfw' boolean (default off)
9920 local to window |local-noglobal|
9921 Keep the window width when windows are opened or closed and
9922 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|.
9923 The width may be changed anyway when running out of room.
9924
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009925 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591*
9926'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1)
9927 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009928 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009929 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00009930 focus goes to a window that is smaller, its size is increased, at the
9931 cost of the height of other windows.
9932 Set 'winheight' to a small number for normal editing.
9933 Set it to 999 to make the current window fill most of the screen.
9934 Other windows will be only 'winminheight' high. This has the drawback
9935 that ":all" will create only two windows. To avoid "vim -o 1 2 3 4"
9936 to create only two windows, set the option after startup is done,
9937 using the |VimEnter| event: >
9938 au VimEnter * set winheight=999
9939< Minimum value is 1.
9940 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands that change the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009941 height of the current window.
9942 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set
9943 the minimal height for other windows.
9944
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009945 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'*
9946'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1)
9947 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009948 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window.
9949 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
9950 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a
9951 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when
9952 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.)
9953 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window.
9954 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
9955 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
9956 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable.
9957
9958 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'*
9959'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1)
9960 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009961 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window.
9962 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
9963 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just
9964 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one
9965 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere
9966 to go.)
9967 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window.
9968 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
9969 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
9970 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable.
9971
Bram Moolenaar9e13aa72017-08-16 23:14:08 +02009972 *'winptydll'*
9973'winptydll' string (default "winpty32.dll" or "winpty64.dll")
9974 global
Bram Moolenaar9e13aa72017-08-16 23:14:08 +02009975 {only available when compiled with the |terminal|
9976 feature on MS-Windows}
9977 Specifies the name of the winpty shared library, used for the
Bram Moolenaare7b1ea02020-08-07 19:54:59 +02009978 |:terminal| command. The default depends on whether Vim was built as a
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +02009979 32-bit or 64-bit executable. If not found, "winpty.dll" is tried as
Bram Moolenaar9e13aa72017-08-16 23:14:08 +02009980 a fallback.
9981 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
9982 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
9983 security reasons.
9984
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009985 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592*
9986'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20)
9987 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009988 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard
9989 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If
9990 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of
9991 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
9992 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing.
9993 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
9994 width of the current window.
9995 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set
9996 the minimal width for other windows.
9997
9998 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'*
9999'wrap' boolean (default on)
10000 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000010001 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text
10002 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that.
10003 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +000010004 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap
10005 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000010006 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll
10007 horizontally.
10008 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See
10009 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary.
10010 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: >
10011 :set sidescroll=5
10012 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:>
10013< See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +010010014 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
10015 on.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000010016
10017 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'*
10018'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0)
10019 local to buffer
10020 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping
10021 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted
10022 and inserting continues on the next line.
10023 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause
10024 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible.
10025 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +020010026 This option is set to 0 when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste'
10027 is reset.
Bram Moolenaara6c27c42019-05-09 19:16:22 +020010028 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000010029
10030 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'*
10031'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385*
10032 global
Bram Moolenaarac6e65f2005-08-29 22:25:38 +000010033 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and
10034 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000010035
10036 *'write'* *'nowrite'*
10037'write' boolean (default on)
10038 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000010039 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed.
10040 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +000010041 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000010042 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires
10043 writing a temporary file.
10044
10045 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'*
10046'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off)
10047 global
10048 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override.
10049
10050 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'*
10051'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off
10052 otherwise)
10053 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000010054 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after
10055 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is
Bram Moolenaar1aeaf8c2012-05-18 13:46:39 +020010056 also on.
10057 WARNING: Switching this option off means that when Vim fails to write
10058 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
10059 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only reset
10060 this option if your file system is almost full and it makes the write
10061 fail (and make sure not to exit Vim until the write was successful).
10062 See |backup-table| for another explanation.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000010063 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +010010064 Depending on 'backupcopy' the backup is a new file or the original
10065 file renamed (and a new file is written).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000010066 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is
10067 set.
10068
10069 *'writedelay'* *'wd'*
10070'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0)
10071 global
Bram Moolenaar802a0d92016-06-26 16:17:58 +020010072 The number of milliseconds to wait for each character sent to the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000010073 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +010010074 one. For debugging purposes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000010075
Bram Moolenaar6f79e612021-12-21 09:12:23 +000010076 *'xtermcodes'* *'noxtermcodes'*
10077'xtermcodes' boolean (default on)
10078 global
10079 When detecting xterm patchlevel 141 or higher with the termresponse
Bram Moolenaarfa3b7232021-12-24 13:18:38 +000010080 mechanism and this option is set, Vim will request the actual terminal
Bram Moolenaar6f79e612021-12-21 09:12:23 +000010081 key codes and number of colors from the terminal. This takes care of
10082 various configuration options of the terminal that cannot be obtained
10083 from the termlib/terminfo entry, see |xterm-codes|.
10084 A side effect may be that t_Co changes and Vim will redraw the
10085 display.
10086
10087
Bram Moolenaar91f84f62018-07-29 15:07:52 +020010088 vim:tw=78:ts=8:noet:ft=help:norl: